blob: 9bba5f6c78d9461062c9f0afb0cf8897086079ae [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewycky5d9484d2013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000024#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
25#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
26#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000034#include <algorithm>
35
36namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000037using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000038
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000039/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000040static ExprResult
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
42 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000043 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
44 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000045 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000046 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
47 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
48 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000049
50 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
51 S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc);
52
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000053 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000054 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
55 if (E.isInvalid())
56 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000057 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000058}
59
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000060static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
61 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000062 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000063 bool CStyle,
64 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000065
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000066static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
67 QualType &ToType,
68 bool InOverloadResolution,
69 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
70 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000071static OverloadingResult
72IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
73 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
74 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
75 bool AllowExplicit);
76
77
78static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
79CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
81 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
82
83static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
84CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
86 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
87
88static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
89CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
90 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
91 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
92
93
94
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000095/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
96/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000097ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000098GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
99 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
100 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
101 ICC_Identity,
102 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
103 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
104 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000105 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
107 ICC_Promotion,
108 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000109 ICC_Promotion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
113 ICC_Conversion,
114 ICC_Conversion,
115 ICC_Conversion,
116 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000117 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000118 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000119 ICC_Conversion,
120 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000121 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000122 ICC_Conversion
123 };
124 return Category[(int)Kind];
125}
126
127/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
128/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
129ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
130 static const ImplicitConversionRank
131 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
132 ICR_Exact_Match,
133 ICR_Exact_Match,
134 ICR_Exact_Match,
135 ICR_Exact_Match,
136 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000137 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000138 ICR_Promotion,
139 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000140 ICR_Promotion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
144 ICR_Conversion,
145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000148 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000149 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000150 ICR_Conversion,
151 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000152 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000154 ICR_Conversion,
155 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000156 };
157 return Rank[(int)Kind];
158}
159
160/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
161/// implicit conversion.
162const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000163 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000164 "No conversion",
165 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
166 "Array-to-pointer",
167 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000168 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000169 "Qualification",
170 "Integral promotion",
171 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000172 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 "Integral conversion",
174 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000175 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000176 "Floating-integral conversion",
177 "Pointer conversion",
178 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000179 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000180 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000181 "Derived-to-base conversion",
182 "Vector conversion",
183 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000184 "Complex-real conversion",
185 "Block Pointer conversion",
186 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000187 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000188 };
189 return Name[Kind];
190}
191
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000192/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
193/// sequence to the identity conversion.
194void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
195 First = ICK_Identity;
196 Second = ICK_Identity;
197 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000198 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000199 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000200 ReferenceBinding = false;
201 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000202 IsLvalueReference = true;
203 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
204 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000205 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000206 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000207 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000208}
209
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
211/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
212/// implicit conversions.
213ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
214 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
215 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
216 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
217 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
218 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
219 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
220 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
221 return Rank;
222}
223
224/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
225/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000226/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000227/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000228bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000229 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
230 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
231 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
232 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000233 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000234 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000237 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
239 return true;
240
241 return false;
242}
243
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000244/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
245/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
246/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
247/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000249StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000250isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000251 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000252 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000253
254 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
255 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
256 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
257 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
258 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
259
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000260 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000261 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000262 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
263
264 return false;
265}
266
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000267/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
268/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
269static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
270 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
271 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
272 case CK_NoOp:
273 case CK_IntegralCast:
274 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
275 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
276 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
277 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
278 case CK_FloatingCast:
279 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
280 continue;
281
282 default:
283 return Converted;
284 }
285 }
286
287 return Converted;
288}
289
290/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
291/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
292///
293/// \param Ctx The AST context.
294/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
295/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
296/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000297/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
298/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000299NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000300StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
301 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000302 APValue &ConstantValue,
303 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000304 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000305
306 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
307 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
308 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
309 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
310 switch (Second) {
311 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
312 //
313 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
314 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
315 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
316 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
317 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
318 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
319 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
320 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
321 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
322 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
323 if (Initializer &&
324 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
325 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
326 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
327 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
328 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
329 // And back.
330 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
331 bool ignored;
332 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
333 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
334 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
335 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
336 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000337 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000338 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
339 }
340 } else {
341 // Variables are always narrowings.
342 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
343 }
344 }
345 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
346
347 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
348 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
349 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
350 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
351 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
352 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
353 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
354 // FromType is larger than ToType.
355 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
356 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
357 // Constant!
358 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
359 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
360 // Convert the source value into the target type.
361 bool ignored;
362 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
363 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
364 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
365 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
366 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000367 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
368 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000369 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000370 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000371 } else {
372 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
373 }
374 }
375 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
376
377 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
378 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
379 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
380 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
381 // value when converted back to the original type.
382 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
383 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
384 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
385 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
386 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
387 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
388 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
389 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
390 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
391 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
392 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
393 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
394 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
395
396 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000397 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
398 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000399 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
400 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
401 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000402 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
403 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
404 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000405 }
406 bool Narrowing = false;
407 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000408 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
409 // narrowing.
410 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000411 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000412 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000413 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
414 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
415 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
416 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
417 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
418 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
419 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
420 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
421 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
422 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
423 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000424 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
425 Narrowing = true;
426 }
427 if (Narrowing) {
428 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
429 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
430 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000431 }
432 }
433 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
434 }
435
436 default:
437 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
438 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
439 }
440}
441
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000442/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
443/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
444void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000445 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000446 bool PrintedSomething = false;
447 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000448 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000449 PrintedSomething = true;
450 }
451
452 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
453 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000456 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000457
458 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000459 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000460 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000461 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000462 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000463 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000464 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000465 PrintedSomething = true;
466 }
467
468 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
469 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000470 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000471 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000473 PrintedSomething = true;
474 }
475
476 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000477 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000478 }
479}
480
481/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
482/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
483void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000484 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000485 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
486 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000487 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000488 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000489 if (ConversionFunction)
490 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
491 else
492 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000493 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000494 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 After.DebugPrint();
496 }
497}
498
499/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
500/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
501void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000502 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000503 switch (ConversionKind) {
504 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000505 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000506 Standard.DebugPrint();
507 break;
508 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000509 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000510 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
511 break;
512 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000513 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000514 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000515 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000516 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000517 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000518 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000519 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000520 break;
521 }
522
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000523 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000524}
525
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000526void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
527 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
528}
529
530void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
531 conversions().~ConversionSet();
532}
533
534void
535AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
536 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
537 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
538 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
539}
540
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000541namespace {
542 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000543 // template argument information.
544 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000545 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
546 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
547 };
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000548 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
549 // template parameter and template argument information.
550 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
551 TemplateParameter Param;
552 };
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000553}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000554
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
556/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
557OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000558static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
559 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000560 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000561 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
562 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000563 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 Result.Data = 0;
565 switch (TDK) {
566 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000567 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000568 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000569 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
570 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000571 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000572
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000573 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000574 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000575 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
576 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000577
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000578 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
579 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
580 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
581 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
582 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
583 Result.Data = Saved;
584 break;
585 }
586
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000587 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000588 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000589 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
590 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000591 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
592 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
593 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
594 Result.Data = Saved;
595 break;
596 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000597
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000598 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000599 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000600 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
601 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
602 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
603 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
604 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
605 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000606 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000607
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000608 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000609 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
610 break;
611
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000612 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000613 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000614 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000615
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 return Result;
617}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000618
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000619void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
620 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
621 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000622 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000623 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
624 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
626 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000627 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000628 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000629 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000630
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000631 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000632 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000633 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000634 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000635 Data = 0;
636 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000637
638 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000639 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000640 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000641 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
642 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
643 HasDiagnostic = false;
644 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000645 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000646
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000647 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000648 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000649 break;
650 }
651}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000652
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000653PartialDiagnosticAt *
654OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
655 if (HasDiagnostic)
656 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
657 return 0;
658}
659
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000660TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
662 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
663 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000664 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000665 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000666 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
667 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000669 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
670 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000671 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000672
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000674 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000675 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000676
677 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000678 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000679 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000680
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000681 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000683 break;
684 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000685
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686 return TemplateParameter();
687}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000688
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000689TemplateArgumentList *
690OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
691 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000692 case Sema::TDK_Success:
693 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
694 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
695 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
696 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
697 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
698 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
699 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
700 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
701 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
702 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
703 return 0;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000704
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000705 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
706 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000707
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000708 // Unhandled
709 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
710 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000711 }
712
713 return 0;
714}
715
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000716const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
717 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
718 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000719 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000720 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
721 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000722 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
723 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000724 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000725 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000726 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000727 return 0;
728
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000730 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
732 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000733
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000734 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000736 break;
737 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000738
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000739 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000740}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000741
742const TemplateArgument *
743OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
744 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
745 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000746 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000747 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
748 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000749 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
750 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000751 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000752 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000753 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000754 return 0;
755
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000757 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
759 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000760
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000761 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000762 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000763 break;
764 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000765
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000766 return 0;
767}
768
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000769Expr *
770OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
771 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
772 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
773 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
774
775 return 0;
776}
777
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000778void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000779 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000780 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
781 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000782 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
783 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
784 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000785}
786
787void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
788 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000789 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000790 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000791 Functions.clear();
792}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000793
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000794namespace {
795 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
796 struct Entry {
797 Expr **Addr;
798 Expr *Saved;
799 };
800 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
801
802 public:
803 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
804 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
805 Entry entry = { &E, E };
806 Entries.push_back(entry);
807 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
808 }
809
810 void restore() {
811 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
812 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
813 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
814 }
815 };
816}
817
818/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
819/// preprocessing on the given expression.
820///
821/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
822/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
823///
824/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
825static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
826 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000827 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
828 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
829 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
830 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
831
832 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
833 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
834 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
835 unbridgedCasts) {
836 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
837 return false;
838 }
839
840 // Go ahead and check everything else.
841 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
842 if (result.isInvalid())
843 return true;
844
845 E = result.take();
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 // Nothing to do.
850 return false;
851}
852
853/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
854/// placeholders.
855static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
856 unsigned numArgs,
857 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
858 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
859 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
860 return true;
861
862 return false;
863}
864
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000865// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000866// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
867// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
868// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
869// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000870// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
871// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
872// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000873//
874// Example: Given the following input:
875//
876// void f(int, float); // #1
877// void f(int, int); // #2
878// int f(int, int); // #3
879//
880// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000881// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000882//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000883// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
884// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
885// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
886// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000887//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000888// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
889// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
890// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
891// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000892// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
893// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000894//
895// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
896// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
897// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
898// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000899Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000900Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
901 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000902 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000903 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000904 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
905
906 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
907 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
908 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
909
910 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
911 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
912 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
913
914 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
915 }
916
917 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
918 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
919 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
920 // function templates hide function templates with different
921 // return types or template parameter lists.
922 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
923 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
924
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000925 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000926 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
927 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
928 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
929 continue;
930 }
931
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000932 Match = *I;
933 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000934 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000935 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000936 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939 continue;
940 }
941
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000942 Match = *I;
943 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000944 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000945 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000946 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
947 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
948 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000949 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
950 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000951 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
952 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
953 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
954 // template instantiation.
955 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000956 // (C++ 13p1):
957 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
958 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000959 Match = *I;
960 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000961 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000962 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000963
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000964 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000965}
966
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000967static bool canBeOverloaded(const FunctionDecl &D) {
968 if (D.getAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
969 return true;
Rafael Espindolad2fdd422013-02-14 01:47:04 +0000970 if (D.isExternC())
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000971 return false;
Rafael Espindola7a525ac2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000972
973 // Main cannot be overloaded (basic.start.main).
974 if (D.isMain())
975 return false;
976
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000977 return true;
978}
979
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000980bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
981 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000982 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
983 // overloads.
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000984 if (!canBeOverloaded(*Old) && !canBeOverloaded(*New))
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000985 return false;
986
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000987 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
988 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
989
990 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
991 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
992 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
993 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
994 return true;
995
996 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
997 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
998 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
999
1000 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1001 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1002 // in the signature, they are overloads.
1003
1004 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1005 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1006 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1007 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1008 return false;
1009
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001010 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1011 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001012
1013 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1014 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1015 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1016 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1017 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
1018 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001019 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001020 return true;
1021
1022 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1023 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1024 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1025 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1026 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1027 // signature.
1028 //
1029 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1030 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001031 //
1032 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1033 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1034 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001035 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1036 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1037 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1038 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
1039 return true;
1040
1041 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001042 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001043 //
1044 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1045 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1046 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1047 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1048 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001049 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1050 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001051 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001052 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1053 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1054 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1055 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1056 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1057 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1058 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1059 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1060 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1061 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1062 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1063 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1064 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1065 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1066 }
1067 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001068 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001069
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001070 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1071 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1072 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1073 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1074 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith714fcc12013-01-14 08:00:39 +00001075 if (NewMethod->isConstexpr() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001076 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1077 if (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewQuals)
1078 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001079 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001080
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001081 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1082 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001083}
1084
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001085/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1086/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1087///
1088/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1089/// an available function, false otherwise.
1090bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1091 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1092}
1093
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001094/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1095///
1096/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1097/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1098static ImplicitConversionSequence
1099TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1100 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1101 bool AllowExplicit,
1102 bool InOverloadResolution,
1103 bool CStyle,
1104 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1105 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1106
1107 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1108 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1109 // we can perform.
1110 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1111 return ICS;
1112 }
1113
1114 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1115 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1116 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1117 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1118 AllowExplicit);
1119
1120 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1121 ICS.setUserDefined();
1122 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1123 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1124 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1125 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1126 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1127 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1128 // called for those cases.
1129 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1130 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1131 QualType FromCanon
1132 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1133 QualType ToCanon
1134 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1135 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1136 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1137 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1138 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1139 ICS.setStandard();
1140 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1141 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1142 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1143 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1144 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1145 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1146 }
1147 }
1148
1149 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1150 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1151 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1152 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1153 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1154 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1155 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1156 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1157 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1158 }
1159 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1160 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1161 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1162 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1163 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1164 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1165 if (Cand->Viable)
1166 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1167 } else {
1168 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1169 }
1170
1171 return ICS;
1172}
1173
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001174/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1175/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1176/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1177/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001178///
1179/// void f(float f);
1180/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1181///
1182/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1183/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1184/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1185/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1186//
1187/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1188/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1189/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1190/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1191/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001192///
1193/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1194/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001195/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1196/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001197///
1198/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1199/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1200/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001201static ImplicitConversionSequence
1202TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1203 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001204 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001205 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001206 bool CStyle,
1207 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001208 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001210 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001211 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001212 return ICS;
1213 }
1214
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001215 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001216 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001217 return ICS;
1218 }
1219
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001220 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1221 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1222 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1223 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1224 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1225 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1226 // called for those cases.
1227 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1228 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001229 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1230 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001231 ICS.setStandard();
1232 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1233 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1234 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001235
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001236 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1237 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1238 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1239 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1240 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001241
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001242 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001243 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001244 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001245
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001246 return ICS;
1247 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001248
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001249 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1250 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1251 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001252}
1253
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001254ImplicitConversionSequence
1255Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1256 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1257 bool AllowExplicit,
1258 bool InOverloadResolution,
1259 bool CStyle,
1260 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1261 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1262 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1263 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1264 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001265}
1266
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001267/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001268/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001269/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1270/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1271/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001272ExprResult
1273Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001274 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001275 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001276 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001277}
1278
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001279ExprResult
1280Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001281 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001282 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001283 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1284 return ExprError();
1285
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001286 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1287 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001288 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001289 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001290
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001291 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1292 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1293 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001294 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001295 /*CStyle=*/false,
1296 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001297 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1298}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001299
1300/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001301/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001302bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1303 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001304 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1305 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001306
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001307 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1308 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1309 // - a pointer
1310 // - a member pointer
1311 // - a block pointer
1312 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1313 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1314 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1315 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1316 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1317 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1318 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1319 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1320 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1321 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1322 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1323 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1324 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1325 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1326 } else {
1327 return false;
1328 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001329
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001330 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1331 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1332 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1333 return false;
1334 }
1335
1336 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1337 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1338 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1339
1340 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1341 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1342 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1343
1344 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001345 return true;
1346}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001347
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001348/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1349/// vector conversion.
1350///
1351/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1352/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001353static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1354 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001355 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1356 // conversion.
1357 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1358 return false;
1359
1360 // Identical types require no conversions.
1361 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1362 return false;
1363
1364 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1365 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1366 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1367 // identity conversion.
1368 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1369 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001370
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001371 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001372 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001373 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1374 return true;
1375 }
1376 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001377
1378 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1379 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1380 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1381 // same size
1382 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1383 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001384 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001385 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001386 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1387 return true;
1388 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001389 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001390
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001391 return false;
1392}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001393
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001394static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1395 bool InOverloadResolution,
1396 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1397 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001398
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001399/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1400/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1401/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1402/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1403/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1404/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1405/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1406/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001407static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1408 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001409 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001410 bool CStyle,
1411 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001412 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001413
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001414 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001415 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001416 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001417 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001418 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001419 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001420
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001421 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001422 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001423 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001424 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001425 return false;
1426
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001427 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001428 }
1429
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001430 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1431 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1432 // (C++ 4p1).
1433
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001434 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001435 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1436 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001437 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001438 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001439 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1440 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1441 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001442
1443 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1444 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1445 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1446 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1447 QualType resultTy;
1448 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001449 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001450 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1451 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1452 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1453 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001454 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001455
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001456 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1457 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1458 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1459 // expression.
1460 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1461 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1462 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1463 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1464 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1465 == UO_AddrOf &&
1466 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1467 const Type *ClassType
1468 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1469 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001470 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1471 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1472 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001473 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1474 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1475 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001476
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001477 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001478 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1479 FromType,
1480 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001481 } else {
1482 return false;
1483 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001484 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001485 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1486 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1487 // be converted to a prvalue.
1488 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001489 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001490 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001491 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001492 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001493
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001494 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1495 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1496 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1497 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1498 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1499
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001500 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1501 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001502 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1503 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001504 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001505 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1506 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001507 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001508
1509 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1510 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1511 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001512 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001513
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001514 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001516 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001517
1518 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1519 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1520 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1521 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001522 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1523 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001524 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001525 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001526 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001527 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001528 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001529 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001530 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001531
1532 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1533 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1534 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001535 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001536 } else {
1537 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001538 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001539 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001540 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001541
1542 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1543 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1544 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1545 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001546 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1547 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001548 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001549 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001550 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001551 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1552 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001553 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001554 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001555 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001556 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001557 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001558 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001559 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001560 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001561 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001562 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001563 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001564 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1565 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001566 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1567 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1568 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1569 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1570 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1571 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1572 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1573 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1574 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001575 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001576 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001577 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001578 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001579 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001580 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001581 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001582 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1583 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001584 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1585 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001586 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1587 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1588 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001589 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001590 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1591 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1592 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001593 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001594 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001595 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001596 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001597 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001598 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001599 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001600 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001601 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1602 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1603 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1604 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001605 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1606 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001607 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001608 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001609 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001610 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001611 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001612 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001613 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001614 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001615 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001616 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1617 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001618 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001619 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001620 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001621 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001622 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001623 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001624 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1625 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001626 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1627 InOverloadResolution,
1628 SCS, CStyle)) {
1629 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1630 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001631 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1632 CStyle)) {
1633 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001634 // appropriately.
1635 return true;
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001636 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1637 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1638 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1639 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1640 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001641 } else {
1642 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001643 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001644 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001645 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001646
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001647 QualType CanonFrom;
1648 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001649 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001650 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1651 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1652 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001653 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001654 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001656 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1657 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001658 } else {
1659 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001660 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1661
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001662 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001663 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1664 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1665 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001666 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1667 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001668 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001669 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian62ac5d02010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001670 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001671 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
Guy Benyei21f18c42013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001672 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime()
1673 || (CanonFrom->isSamplerT() &&
1674 CanonFrom.getAddressSpace() != CanonTo.getAddressSpace()))) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001675 FromType = ToType;
1676 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1677 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001678 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001679 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001680
1681 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1682 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001683 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001684 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001685
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001686 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001687}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001688
1689static bool
1690IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1691 QualType &ToType,
1692 bool InOverloadResolution,
1693 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1694 bool CStyle) {
1695
1696 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1697 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1698 return false;
1699 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1700 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1701 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1702 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1703 itend = UD->field_end();
1704 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001705 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1706 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001707 ToType = it->getType();
1708 return true;
1709 }
1710 }
1711 return false;
1712}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001713
1714/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1715/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1716/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1717/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001718bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001719 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001720 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001721 if (!To) {
1722 return false;
1723 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001724
1725 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1726 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1727 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1728 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1729 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001730 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1731 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001732 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1733 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1734 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1735 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001736 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001737 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001738 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001739 }
1740
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001741 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1742 }
1743
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001744 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001745 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1746 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1747 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1748 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1749 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001750 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001751 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001752 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001753 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1754 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001755 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001756 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1757 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1758 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1759 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1760 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1761 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001762 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1763 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1764 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1765 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1766 return false;
1767
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001768 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1769 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1770 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1771 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1772 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1773 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1774 }
1775
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001776 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001777 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001778 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001779 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1780 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001781 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001782
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001783 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1785 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1786 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001787 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001788 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001789 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001790 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001791 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001792 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001793 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001794 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1795 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001796 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001797 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001798
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001799 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1800 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001801 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1802 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001803 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1804 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001805 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001806 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001807 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1808 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001809 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001810 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1811 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1812 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1813 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001814 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001815 }
1816 }
1817 }
1818
1819 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1820 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1821 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1822 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1823 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1824 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1825 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001826 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1827 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001828 using llvm::APSInt;
1829 if (From)
1830 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001831 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001832 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001833 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1834 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1835 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001836
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001837 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1838 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1839 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1840 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1841 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001842
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001843 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1844 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1845 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1846 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1847 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001848
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001849 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001850 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001851 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001852
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001853 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1854 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001855 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001856 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001857 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001858
1859 return false;
1860}
1861
1862/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1863/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1864/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001865bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001866 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1867 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001868 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1869 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001870 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1871 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1872 return true;
1873
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001874 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1875 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1876 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001877 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001878 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1879 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1880 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1881 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001882
1883 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001884 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1885 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001886 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1887 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001888 }
1889
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001890 return false;
1891}
1892
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001893/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1894///
1895/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1896/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001897/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001898bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001899 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001900 if (!FromComplex)
1901 return false;
1902
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001903 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001904 if (!ToComplex)
1905 return false;
1906
1907 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001908 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1909 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1910 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001911}
1912
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001913/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1914/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1915/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1916/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1917/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001918///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001919static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001920BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001921 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001922 ASTContext &Context,
1923 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001924 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1925 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1926 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001927
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001928 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1929 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001930 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001931
1932 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001933 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001934 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001935 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001936
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001937 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1938 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1939
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001940 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001941 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001942 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001943 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001944 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001945
1946 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1947 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001948 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1949 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001950 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1951 }
1952
1953 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001954 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1955 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001956
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001957 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1958 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1959 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001960}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001961
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001962static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001963 bool InOverloadResolution,
1964 ASTContext &Context) {
1965 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1966 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1967 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001968 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001969 return !InOverloadResolution;
1970
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001971 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1972 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1973 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001974}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001975
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001976/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1977/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1978/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1979/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1980/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1981/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001982///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001983/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1984/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1985/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1986/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1987/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1988/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001989/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1990/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1991/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001992bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001993 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001994 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001995 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001996 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001997 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1998 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001999 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002000
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002001 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2002 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002003 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002004 ConvertedType = ToType;
2005 return true;
2006 }
2007
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002008 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2009 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002010 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002011 ConvertedType = ToType;
2012 return true;
2013 }
2014 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2015 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002016 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002017 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002018 ConvertedType = ToType;
2019 return true;
2020 }
2021
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002022 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2023 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002024 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002025 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002026 ConvertedType = ToType;
2027 return true;
2028 }
2029
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002030 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002031 if (!ToTypePtr)
2032 return false;
2033
2034 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002035 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002036 ConvertedType = ToType;
2037 return true;
2038 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002039
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002040 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002041 // , including objective-c pointers.
2042 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002043 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002044 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002045 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2046 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2047 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002048 ToType, Context);
2049 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002050 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002051 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002052 if (!FromTypePtr)
2053 return false;
2054
2055 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002056
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002057 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002058 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2059 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2060 return false;
2061
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002062 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2063 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2064 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002065 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2066 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002067 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002068 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002069 ToType, Context,
2070 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002071 return true;
2072 }
2073
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002074 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002075 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002076 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2077 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2078 ToPointeeType,
2079 ToType, Context);
2080 return true;
2081 }
2082
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002083 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2084 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002085 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002086 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002088 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002089 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002090 return true;
2091 }
2092
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002093 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002094 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002095 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2096 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2097 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2098 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2099 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2100 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2101 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2102 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2103 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002104 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2105 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002106 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002107 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002108 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002109 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002110 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002111 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002112 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002113 ToType, Context);
2114 return true;
2115 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002116
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002117 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2118 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2119 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2120 ToPointeeType,
2121 ToType, Context);
2122 return true;
2123 }
2124
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002125 return false;
2126}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002127
2128/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2129static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2130 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2131
2132 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2133 if (TQs == Qs)
2134 return T;
2135
2136 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2137 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2138
2139 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2140}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002141
2142/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2143/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2144/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002146 QualType& ConvertedType,
2147 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002148 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002149 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002150
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002151 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2152 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2153
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002154 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002155 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2156 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002157 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002158 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002159
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002160 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002161 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2162 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2163 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2164 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2165 return false;
2166
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002167 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002168 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002169 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002170 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002171 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002172 return true;
2173 }
2174 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002175 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002176 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002177 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002178 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002179 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002180 return true;
2181 }
2182 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2183 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2184 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002185 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2186 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002187 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002188 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2189 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2190 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002191 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002192 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2193 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002194 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002195 return true;
2196 }
2197
2198 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2199 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2200 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2201 // complain about it.
2202 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002203 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002204 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2205 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002206 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002207 return true;
2208 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002209 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002210 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002211 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002212 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002213 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002214 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002215 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002216 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002217 // to a block pointer type.
2218 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002219 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002220 return true;
2221 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002222 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002223 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002224 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002225 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002226 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002227 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002228 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002229 return true;
2230 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002231 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002232 return false;
2233
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002234 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002235 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002236 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002237 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2238 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002239 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2240 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002241 return false;
2242
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002243 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2244 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2245 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2246 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2247 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2248 // We always complain about this conversion.
2249 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002250 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002251 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002252 return true;
2253 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002254 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2255 // as in I* to id.
2256 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2257 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2258 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2259 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002260
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002261 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002262 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002263 return true;
2264 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002265
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002266 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002267 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2268 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2269 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002270 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002271 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002272 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002273 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002274 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2275 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2276 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2277 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2278 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2279 return false;
2280
2281 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2282 // function types are obviously different.
2283 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2284 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2285 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2286 return false;
2287
2288 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2289 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2290 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2291 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2292 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2293 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2294 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2295 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2296 HasObjCConversion = true;
2297 } else {
2298 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2299 return false;
2300 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002301
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002302 // Check argument types.
2303 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2304 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2305 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2306 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2307 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2308 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2309 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2310 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2311 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2312 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2313 HasObjCConversion = true;
2314 } else {
2315 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2316 return false;
2317 }
2318 }
2319
2320 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2321 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2322 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002323 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002324 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2325 return true;
2326 }
2327 }
2328
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002329 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002330}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002331
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002332/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2333/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2334///
2335/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2336///
2337/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2338///
2339/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2340/// this conversion.
2341bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2342 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002343 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002344 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2345 return false;
2346
2347 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2348 QualType ToPointee;
2349 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2350 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2351 else
2352 return false;
2353
2354 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2355 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2356 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002357 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002358 return false;
2359
2360 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2361 QualType FromPointee;
2362 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2363 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2364 else
2365 return false;
2366
2367 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2368 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2369 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2370 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2371 return false;
2372
2373 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2374 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2375 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2376 return false;
2377
2378 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2379 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2380 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2381 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2382
2383 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2384 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2385 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2386 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2387 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2388 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2389 IncompatibleObjC))
2390 return false;
2391
2392 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2393 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2394 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2395 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2396 return true;
2397}
2398
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002399bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2400 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2401 QualType ToPointeeType;
2402 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2403 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2404 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2405 else
2406 return false;
2407
2408 QualType FromPointeeType;
2409 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2410 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2411 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2412 else
2413 return false;
2414 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2415 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2416 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2417
2418 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2419 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2420 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2421 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2422
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002423 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2424 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002425
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002426 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002427 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002428
2429 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2430 // function types are obviously different.
2431 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2432 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2433 return false;
2434
2435 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2436 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2437 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2438 return false;
2439
2440 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002441 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2442 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002443 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2444 } else {
2445 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2446 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002447 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002448 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2449 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2450
2451 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2452 // OK exact match.
2453 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2454 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2455 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2456 return false;
2457 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2458 }
2459 else
2460 return false;
2461 }
2462
2463 // Check argument types.
2464 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2465 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2466 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2467 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2468 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2469 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2470 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2471 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2472 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2473 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2474 return false;
2475 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2476 } else
2477 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2478 return false;
2479 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002480 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2481 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2482 ToFunctionType))
2483 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002484
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002485 ConvertedType = ToType;
2486 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002487}
2488
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002489enum {
2490 ft_default,
2491 ft_different_class,
2492 ft_parameter_arity,
2493 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2494 ft_return_type,
2495 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2496};
2497
2498/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2499/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2500/// parameter types, and different return types.
2501void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2502 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002503 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2504 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2505 PDiag << ft_default;
2506 return;
2507 }
2508
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002509 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2510 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2511 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2512 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2513 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2514 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2515 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2516 return;
2517 }
2518 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2519 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002520 }
2521
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002522 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2523 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2524 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2525 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2526
2527 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002528 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2529 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2530
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002531 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2532 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2533 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2534 PDiag << ft_default;
2535 return;
2536 }
2537
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002538 // No extra info for same types.
2539 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2540 PDiag << ft_default;
2541 return;
2542 }
2543
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002544 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2545 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2546
2547 // Both types need to be function types.
2548 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2549 PDiag << ft_default;
2550 return;
2551 }
2552
2553 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2554 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2555 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2556 return;
2557 }
2558
2559 // Handle different parameter types.
2560 unsigned ArgPos;
2561 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2562 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2563 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2564 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2565 return;
2566 }
2567
2568 // Handle different return type.
2569 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2570 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2571 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2572 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2573 return;
2574 }
2575
2576 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2577 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2578 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2579 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2580 return;
2581 }
2582
2583 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2584 PDiag << ft_default;
2585}
2586
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002587/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002588/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002589/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2590/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Sylvestre Ledrubed28ac2012-07-23 08:59:39 +00002591/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the parameter index
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002592/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002593bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002594 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2595 unsigned *ArgPos) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002596 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002597 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2598 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2599 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2600 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2601 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2602 return false;
2603 }
2604 }
2605 return true;
2606 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002607
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002608 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2609 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2610 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2611 QualType ToType = (*O);
2612 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002613 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002614 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2615 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth0ee93de2010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002616 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2617 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2618 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2619 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002620 continue;
2621 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002622 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2623 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002624 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002625 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002626 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2627 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2628 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002629 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002630 }
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002631 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002632 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002633 }
2634 }
2635 return true;
2636}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002637
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002638/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2639/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002640/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002641/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2642/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2643/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002644bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002645 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002646 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002647 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002648 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002649 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002650
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002651 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2652
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002653 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2654 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2655 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2656 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2657 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2658 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2659 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2660 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2661 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2662 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2663 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002664 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2665 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002666 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2667 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002668
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002669 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2670 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002671 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2672 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002673 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2674 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002675 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002676 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002677 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002678
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002679 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002680 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002681 }
2682 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002683 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2684 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2685 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2686 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002687 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2688 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2689 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002690 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002691 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002692 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2693 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2694 } else {
2695 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002696 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002697 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2698 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2699 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002700 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002701
2702 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2703 // reasons.
2704 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2705 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2706
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002707 return false;
2708}
2709
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002710/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2711/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2712/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2713/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2714/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2715bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002716 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002717 bool InOverloadResolution,
2718 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002719 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002720 if (!ToTypePtr)
2721 return false;
2722
2723 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002724 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2725 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2726 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002727 ConvertedType = ToType;
2728 return true;
2729 }
2730
2731 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002732 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002733 if (!FromTypePtr)
2734 return false;
2735
2736 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2737 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2738 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2739 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002740
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002741 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002742 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002743 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002744 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2745 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2746 return true;
2747 }
2748
2749 return false;
2750}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002751
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002752/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2753/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002754/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002755/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2756/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2757/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002758bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002759 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002760 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002761 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002762 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002763 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002764 if (!FromPtrType) {
2765 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002766 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002767 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002768 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002769 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002770 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002771 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002772
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002773 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002774 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2775 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002776
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002777 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2778 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002779
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002780 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2781 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2782 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002783
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002784 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002785 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002786 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2787 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2788 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2789 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002790
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002791 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2792 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002793 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2794 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2795 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2796 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002797 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002798
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002799 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002800 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2801 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2802 << From->getSourceRange();
2803 return true;
2804 }
2805
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002806 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002807 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2808 Paths.front(),
2809 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002810
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002811 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002812 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002813 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002814 return false;
2815}
2816
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002817/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2818/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2819/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002820///
2821/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2822/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2823/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002824bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002825Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002826 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002827 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2828 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002829 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2830
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002831 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2832 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002833 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002834 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002835
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002836 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2837 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2838 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2839 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002840 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002841 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002842 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2843 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2844 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002845 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002846 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2847 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002848 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002849
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002850 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2851 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2852
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002853 // Objective-C ARC:
2854 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2855 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2856 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2857 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2858 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2859 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2860 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2861 } else {
2862 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2863 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2864 return false;
2865 }
2866 }
2867
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002868 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2869 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2870 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2871 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2872 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2873 }
2874
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002875 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2876 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002877 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002878 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002879
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002880 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2881 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002882 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002883 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002884 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002885
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002886 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2887 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002888 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002889 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002890 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002891
2892 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2893 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2894 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2895 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2896 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002897 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002898}
2899
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002900/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2901/// atomic type.
2902///
2903/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2904/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002905static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2906 bool InOverloadResolution,
2907 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2908 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002909 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2910 if (!ToAtomic)
2911 return false;
2912
2913 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2914 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2915 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2916 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2917 return false;
2918
2919 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2920 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2921 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2922 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2923 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2924 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2925 return true;
2926}
2927
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002928static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2929 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2930 QualType Type) {
2931 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2932 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2933 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2934 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2935 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2936 return true;
2937 }
2938 return false;
2939}
2940
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002941static OverloadingResult
2942IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2943 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2944 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2945 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2946 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002947 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2948 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002949 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2950 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2951 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2952
2953 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2954 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2955 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2956 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2957 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2958 Constructor
2959 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2960 else
2961 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2962
2963 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2964 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2965 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2966 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002967 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2968 // suppress conversions.
2969 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2970 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002971 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2972 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2973 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002974 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002975 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002976 else
2977 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002978 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002979 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002980 }
2981 }
2982
2983 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2984
2985 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2986 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2987 case OR_Success: {
2988 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2989 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002990 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2991 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2992 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2993 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2994 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2995 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2996 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2997 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2998 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2999 return OR_Success;
3000 }
3001
3002 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3003 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3004 case OR_Deleted:
3005 return OR_Deleted;
3006 case OR_Ambiguous:
3007 return OR_Ambiguous;
3008 }
3009
3010 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3011}
3012
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003013/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3014/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3015/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3016/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3017/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3018/// false and User is unspecified.
3019///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003020/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3021/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3022/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003023static OverloadingResult
3024IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003025 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3026 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003027 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003028 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3029 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3030
3031 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3032 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003033 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003034 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3035 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3036 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3037 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3038 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3039 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3040 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3041 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003042 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003043 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003044 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003045 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3046
Benjamin Kramer63b6ebe2012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003047 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003048 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3049 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3050 // to try to recover.
3051 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003052 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3053 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3054 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003055
3056 Expr **Args = &From;
3057 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3058 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003059 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003060 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
3061 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3062 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3063 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3064 return Result;
3065 // Never mind.
3066 CandidateSet.clear();
3067
3068 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3069 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003070 Args = InitList->getInits();
3071 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3072 ListInitializing = true;
3073 }
3074
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003075 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3076 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003077 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003078 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3079 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3080
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003081 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3082 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3083 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003084 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003085 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003086 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003087 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3088 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003089 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003090
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003091 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3092 if (ListInitializing)
3093 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3094 else
3095 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3096 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003097 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3098 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3099 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3100 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3101 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3102 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003103 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3104 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003105 }
3106 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003107 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003108 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3109 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003110 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003111 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003112 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003113 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3114 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003115 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003116 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003117 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003118 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003119 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003120 }
3121 }
3122
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003123 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003124 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003125 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003126 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003127 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003128 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003129 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003130 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3131 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003132 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3133 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3134 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3135 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3136 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003137 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3138 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003139 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3140 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3141 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3142
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003143 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3144 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003145 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3146 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003147 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003148 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003149
3150 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3151 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003152 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3153 ActingContext, From, ToType,
3154 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003155 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003156 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3157 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003158 }
3159 }
3160 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003161 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003162
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003163 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3164
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003165 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003166 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003167 case OR_Success:
3168 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3169 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3170 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3171 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3172 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3173 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3174 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3175 // the argument of the constructor.
3176 //
3177 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003178 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3179 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3180 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3181 } else {
3182 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3183 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3184 else {
3185 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3186 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3187 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003188 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003189 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003190 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003191 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003192 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3193 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3194 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3195 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003196 }
3197 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003198 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3199 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3200 //
3201 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3202 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3203 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3204 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3205 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003206 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003207 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003208 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003209 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003210
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003211 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3212 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3213 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3214 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3215 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3216 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3217 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3218 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3219 // 13.3.3.1).
3220 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3221 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003222 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003223 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003224
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003225 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3226 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3227 case OR_Deleted:
3228 // No conversion here! We're done.
3229 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003230
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003231 case OR_Ambiguous:
3232 return OR_Ambiguous;
3233 }
3234
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003235 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003236}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003237
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003238bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003239Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003240 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003241 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003242 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003243 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003244 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003245 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003246 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003247 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3248 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3249 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003250 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003251 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3252 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3253 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003254 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003255 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003256 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003257}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003258
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003259/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3260/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3261/// is possible.
3262static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3263compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3264 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3265 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003266 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003267 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3268
3269 // Objective-C++:
3270 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3271 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3272 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3273 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3274 // to keep code working.
3275 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3276 if (!Conv1)
3277 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3278
3279 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3280 if (!Conv2)
3281 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3282
3283 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3284 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3285 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3286 if (Block1 != Block2)
3287 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3288 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3289 }
3290
3291 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3292}
3293
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003294/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3295/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3296/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003297static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3298CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3299 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3300 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003301{
3302 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3303 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3304 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3305 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3306 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3307 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3308 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3309 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003310 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003311 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3312 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3313 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3314 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3315 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003316 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3317 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003318 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003319 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003320
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003321 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3322 // the same kind.
3323 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3324 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3325
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003326 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3327 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3328
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003329 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3330 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3331 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003332 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003333 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3334 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003335 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003336 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3337 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3338 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3339 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3340 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3341 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003342 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003343 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003344 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3345 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3346 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003347 else
3348 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3349 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3350 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003351 }
3352
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003353 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3354 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3355 // for some X and L2 does not.
3356 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003357 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003358 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3359 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003360 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3361 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3362 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3363 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3364 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3365 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003366 }
3367
3368 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003369}
3370
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003371static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3372 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3373 Qualifiers Quals;
3374 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003375 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003376 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003377
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003378 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3379}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003380
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003381// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3382// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3383static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3384compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3385 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3386 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3387 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3388 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3389
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003390 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003391 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003392 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3393 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3394 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3395 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003396
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003397 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3398 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3399 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3400 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3401 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3402 else
3403 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003404 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003405 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3406
3407 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3408 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3409 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3410 }
3411
3412 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3413 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3414 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3415 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3416
3417 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3418 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3419 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3420 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003421
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003422 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3423}
3424
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003425/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3426/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3427static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3428 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3429 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3430 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3431 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003432 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003433 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003434 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003435 // reference*.
3436 //
3437 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3438 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3439 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3440 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3441 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003442 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3443 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3444 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003445
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003446 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3447 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3448 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3449 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3450}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003451
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003452/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3453/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3454/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003455static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3456CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3457 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3458 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003459{
3460 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3461 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3462
3463 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3464 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3465 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3466 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3467 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003468 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003469 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003470 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003471
3472 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3473 // defined below), or, if not that,
3474 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3475 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3476 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3477 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3478 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3479 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003480
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003481 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3482 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3483 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003484
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003485 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3486 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3487 // that is such a conversion.
3488 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3489 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3490 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3491 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3492
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003493 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3494 //
3495 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003496 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3497 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3498 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003499 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003500 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003501 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003502 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003503 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3504 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3505 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003506 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3507 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003508 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3509 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3510 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003511 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003512 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003513 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003514 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3515 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003516 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3517 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3518 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003519 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3520 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003521
3522 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3523 // conversion, if we need to.
3524 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003525 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003526 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003527 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003528
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003529 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3530 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003531
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003532 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003533 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003534 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003535 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3536
3537 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3538 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003539 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3540 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3541 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3542 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3543 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3544 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3545 FromObjCPtr2);
3546 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3547 FromObjCPtr1);
3548 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3549 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3550 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3551 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003552 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003553 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003554
3555 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3556 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003557 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003558 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003559 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003560
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003561 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003562 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3563 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3564 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3565 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3566 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003567
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003568 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3569 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3570 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3571 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3572 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3573 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003574 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3575 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003576 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3577 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003578 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003579 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3580 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003581 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003582 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3583 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3584 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3585 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3586 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3587 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3588 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3589 }
3590
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003591 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3592 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003593 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003594 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003595 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003596 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003597 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3599 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003600 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003601 }
3602 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003603
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003604 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3605 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3606 // is between types of the same size.
3607 // For example:
3608 // void f(float);
3609 // void f(int);
3610 // int main {
3611 // long a;
3612 // f(a);
3613 // }
3614 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3615 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003616 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003617 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3618 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3619 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3620 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3621 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3622
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003623 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3624}
3625
3626/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3627/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003628/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3629ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003630CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3631 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3632 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003633 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003634 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3635 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3636 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3637 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3638 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3639 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3640 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3641 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3642
3643 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3644 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003645 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3646 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003647 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3648 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003649 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003650 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3651 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003652
3653 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3654 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003655 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003656 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3657
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003658 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3659 // for comparison.
3660 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003661 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003662 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003663 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003664
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003665 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003666 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003667
3668 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3669 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3670 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3671 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3672 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3673 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3674 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3675 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3676 }
3677
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003678 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003679 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3680 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3681 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003682 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003683 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3684 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3685 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3686 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3687 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3688 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3689 // about how the sequences rank.
3690 ;
3691 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3692 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3693 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3694 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3695 // qualifiers.
3696 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003697
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003698 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3699 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3700 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3701 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3702 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3703 // qualifiers.
3704 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003705
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003706 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3707 } else {
3708 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3709 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3710 }
3711
3712 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003713 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003714 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003715 }
3716
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003717 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3718 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3719 switch (Result) {
3720 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003721 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003722 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3723 break;
3724
3725 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3726 break;
3727
3728 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003729 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003730 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3731 break;
3732 }
3733
3734 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003735}
3736
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003737/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3738/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003739/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3740/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3741/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003742ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003743CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3744 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3745 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003746 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003747 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003748 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003749 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003750
3751 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3752 // conversion, if we need to.
3753 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003754 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003755 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003756 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003757
3758 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003759 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3760 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3761 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3762 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003763
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003764 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003765 //
3766 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3767 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003768 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003769 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003770 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003771 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3772 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3773 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3774 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003775 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003776 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003777 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003778 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003779 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003780 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003781 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003782 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003783
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003784 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003785 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003786 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003787 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003788 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003789 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3790 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003791
3792 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3793 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003794 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003795 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003796 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003797 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003798 }
3799 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3800 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3801 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3802 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3803 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3804 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3805 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3806 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3807 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3808 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3809
3810 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3811 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3812 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3813 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3814 // Objective-C pointer types.
3815 bool FromAssignLeft
3816 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3817 bool FromAssignRight
3818 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3819 bool ToAssignLeft
3820 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3821 bool ToAssignRight
3822 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3823
3824 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3825 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3826 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3827 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3829 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3830 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3831 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3832
3833 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3834 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3835 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3836 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3837 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3838 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3839
3840 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3841 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3842 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3843 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3844 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3845 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3846 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3847 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3848
3849 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3850 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3851 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3852 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3853 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3854 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003855
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003856 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3857 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3858 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3859 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3860 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3861 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3862
3863 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3864 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3865 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3866 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3867 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003868 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003869 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003870
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003871 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003872 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3873 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3874 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003875 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003876 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003877 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003878 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003879 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003880 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003881 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003882 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3883 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3884 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3885 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3886 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3887 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3888 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3889 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3890 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003891 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003892 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003893 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003894 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003895 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003896 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3897 }
3898 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3899 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003900 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003901 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003902 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003903 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3904 }
3905 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003906
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003907 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003908 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003909 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3910 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3911 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003912 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3913 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3914 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003915 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003916 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003917 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3918 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003919
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003920 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003921 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3922 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3923 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003924 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3925 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3926 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003927 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003928 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003929 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3930 }
3931 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003932
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003933 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3934}
3935
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003936/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3937/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3938/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3939/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3940/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3941/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3942/// type being initialized.
3943Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3944Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3945 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003946 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003947 bool &ObjCConversion,
3948 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003949 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3950 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3951 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3952
3953 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3954 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3955 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3956 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3957 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3958
3959 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3960 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3961 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3962 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003963 DerivedToBase = false;
3964 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003965 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003966 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3967 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003968 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003969 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3970 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003971 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3972 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3973 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3974 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003975 else
3976 return Ref_Incompatible;
3977
3978 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3979 // least).
3980
3981 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3982 // for comparison.
3983 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3984 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3985 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3986 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3987
3988 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3989 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3990 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3991 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3992 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3993 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3994 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003995 //
3996 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3997 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3998 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3999 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004000 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4001 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
4002 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4003 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4004 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4005 }
4006
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004007 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004008 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004009 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004010 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4011 else
4012 return Ref_Related;
4013}
4014
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004015/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004016/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4017static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004018FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4019 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4020 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4021 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004022 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4023 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4024 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4025
4026 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004027 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4028 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4029 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4030 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4031 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004032 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4033 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4034 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4035 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4036
4037 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4038 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4039 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4040 if (ConvTemplate)
4041 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4042 else
4043 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4044
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004045 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004046 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4047 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4048 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004049
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004050 if (AllowRvalues) {
4051 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4052 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004053 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004054
4055 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4056 // functions that return lvalues.
4057 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4058 const ReferenceType *RefType
4059 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4060 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4061 continue;
4062 }
4063
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004064 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004065 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4066 DeclLoc,
4067 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4068 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4069 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004070 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004071 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004072 continue;
4073 } else {
4074 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4075 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4076 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4077
4078 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4079 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4080 if (!RefType ||
4081 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4082 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4083 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004084 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004085
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004086 if (ConvTemplate)
4087 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004088 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004089 else
4090 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004091 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004092 }
4093
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004094 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4095
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004096 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004097 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004098 case OR_Success:
4099 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4100 //
4101 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4102 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4103 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4104 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4105 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4106 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4107 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4108 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4109 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4110 return false;
4111
4112 ICS.setUserDefined();
4113 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4114 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004115 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004116 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004117 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004118 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4119 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4120 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4121 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4122 return true;
4123
4124 case OR_Ambiguous:
4125 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4126 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4127 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4128 if (Cand->Viable)
4129 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4130 return true;
4131
4132 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4133 case OR_Deleted:
4134 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4135 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4136 return false;
4137 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004138
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004139 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004140}
4141
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004142/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4143/// initialization.
4144static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004145TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004146 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4147 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004148 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004149 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4150
4151 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4152 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4153 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4154
4155 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4156 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4157
4158 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4159 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4160 // type of the resulting function.
4161 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4162 DeclAccessPair Found;
4163 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4164 false, Found))
4165 T2 = Fn->getType();
4166 }
4167
4168 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4169 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4170 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004171 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004172 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004173 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004174 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004175 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004176 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004177
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004178
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004179 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004180 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4181 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4182
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004183 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004184 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004185 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4186 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4187 //
4188 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4189 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4190 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004191 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004192 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4193 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4194 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4195 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4196 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4197 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4198 ICS.setStandard();
4199 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004200 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4201 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4202 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004203 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4204 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4205 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4206 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4207 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4208 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4209 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004210 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4211 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4212 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004213 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004214 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004215 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004216
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004217 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4218 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4219 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4220 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004221 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004222 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004223
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004224 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4225 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4226 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4227 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4228 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4229 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4230 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4231 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004232 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004233 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004234 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4235 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4236 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004237 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004238 }
4239 }
4240
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004241 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4242 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004243 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004244 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004245 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4246 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4247 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4248 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4249 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4250 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4251 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004252 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4253 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004254 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004255 return ICS;
4256
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004257 // -- If the initializer expression
4258 //
4259 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004260 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004261 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4262 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4263 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4264 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4265 ICS.setStandard();
4266 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004267 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004268 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4269 : ICK_Identity;
4270 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4271 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4272 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4273 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4274 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4275 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4276 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4277 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4278 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4279 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4280 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004281 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004282 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004283 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004284 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4285 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004286 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004287 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004288 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004289 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004290 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004291 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004292
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004293 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4294 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004295 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4296 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004297 // "cv3 T3",
4298 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004299 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004300 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004301 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004302 // class subobject).
4303 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004304 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004305 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4306 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4307 AllowExplicit)) {
4308 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4309 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4310 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4311 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004312 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004313 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4314 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4315
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004316 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004317 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004318
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004319 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4320 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4321 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4322 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4323 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4324 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4325 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4326 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4327 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4328 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4329 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4330 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004331 //
4332 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4333 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4334 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4335 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4336 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4337 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4338 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4339 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4340 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4341 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004342 }
4343
4344 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4345 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4346 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4347 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4348 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4349 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4350 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4351 return ICS;
4352
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004353 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4354 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4355 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4356 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4357 return ICS;
4358
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004359 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004360 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4361 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4362 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4363 // underlying type of the reference according to
4364 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4365 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4366 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4367 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4368 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004369 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4370 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004371 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004372 /*CStyle=*/false,
4373 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004374
4375 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4376 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4377 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004378 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4379 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4380 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004381 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004382 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004383 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004384 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4385 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4386 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4387 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4388 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4389 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4391 DeclType);
4392 return ICS;
4393 }
4394 }
4395 }
4396
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004397 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004398 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4399 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4400 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4401 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4402 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004403 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004404
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004405 return ICS;
4406}
4407
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004408static ImplicitConversionSequence
4409TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4410 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4411 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004412 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4413 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004414
4415/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4416/// initializer list From.
4417static ImplicitConversionSequence
4418TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4419 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4420 bool InOverloadResolution,
4421 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4422 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4423 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4424 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4425
4426 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4427 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004428 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004429
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004430 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004431 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004432 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004433 return Result;
4434
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004435 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4436 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4437 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4438 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4439 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004440 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004441 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004442 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith2801d9a2012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004443 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004444 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004445 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004446 if (!X.isNull()) {
4447 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4448 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4449 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4450 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4451 InOverloadResolution,
4452 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4453 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4454 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4455 Result = ICS;
4456 break;
4457 }
4458 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4459 if (Result.isBad() ||
4460 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4461 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4462 Result = ICS;
4463 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004464
4465 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4466 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4467 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4468 Result.setStandard();
4469 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4470 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4471 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4472 }
4473
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004474 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004475 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004476 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004477 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004478
4479 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4480 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4481 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4482 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4483 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4484 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004485 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4486 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4487 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4488 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4489 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4490 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4491 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004492 return Result;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004493 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004494
4495 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4496 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4497 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4498 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004499 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004500 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4501 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4502 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4503 InitializedEntity Entity =
4504 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4505 /*Consumed=*/false);
4506 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4507 Result.setUserDefined();
4508 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4509 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4510 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4511 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4512
4513 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4514 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4515 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004516 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004517 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004518 return Result;
4519 }
4520
4521 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4522 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004523 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4524 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4525 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4526 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4527
4528 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4529
4530 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4531 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4532 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4533 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4534
4535 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4536
4537 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4538 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4539 // type of the resulting function.
4540 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4541 DeclAccessPair Found;
4542 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4543 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4544 T2 = Fn->getType();
4545 }
4546
4547 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4548 bool dummy1 = false;
4549 bool dummy2 = false;
4550 bool dummy3 = false;
4551 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4552 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4553 dummy2, dummy3);
4554
4555 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4556 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4557 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4558 SuppressUserConversions,
4559 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4560 }
4561
4562 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4563 // initializer list.
4564 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4565 InOverloadResolution,
4566 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4567 if (Result.isFailure())
4568 return Result;
4569 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4570 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4571
4572 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4573 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4574 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4575 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4576 Result.UserDefined.After;
4577 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4578 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4579 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4580 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4581 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4582 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4583 } else
4584 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4585 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004586 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004587 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004588
4589 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4590 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4591 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4592 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4593 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4594 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004595 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4596 if (NumInits == 1)
4597 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4598 SuppressUserConversions,
4599 InOverloadResolution,
4600 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4601 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4602 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4603 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4604 Result.setStandard();
4605 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004606 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4607 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004608 }
Sebastian Redl2422e822012-02-28 23:36:38 +00004609 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004610 return Result;
4611 }
4612
4613 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4614 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4615 return Result;
4616}
4617
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004618/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4619/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4620/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4621/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004622/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004623/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004624static ImplicitConversionSequence
4625TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004626 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004627 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004628 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4629 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004630 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4631 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4632 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4633
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004634 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004635 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004636 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4637 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004638 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004639
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004640 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4641 SuppressUserConversions,
4642 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004643 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004644 /*CStyle=*/false,
4645 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004646}
4647
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004648static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4649 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4650 Sema &S,
4651 SourceLocation Loc,
4652 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4653 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4654 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4655 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4656
4657 return !ICS.isBad();
4658}
4659
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004660/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4661/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4662/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004663static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004664TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004665 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004666 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4667 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4668 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004669 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4670 // const volatile object.
4671 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4672 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004673 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004674
4675 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4676 // to exit early.
4677 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004678
4679 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004680 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004681 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4682
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004683 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4684 // better have an lvalue.
4685 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4686 }
4687
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004688 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004689
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004690 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004691 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004692 // parameter is
4693 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004694 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4695 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4696 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004697 // ref-qualifier
4698 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004699 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004700 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4701 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004702 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004703 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004704 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4705 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4706 // non-constant references.
4707
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004708 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004709 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004710 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004711 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004712 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004713 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004714 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004715 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004716 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004717
4718 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4719 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004720 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004721 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4722 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4723 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004724 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004725 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004726 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004727 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4728 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004729 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004730 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004731
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004732 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4733 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4734 case RQ_None:
4735 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4736 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004737
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004738 case RQ_LValue:
4739 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4740 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004741 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004742 ImplicitParamType);
4743 return ICS;
4744 }
4745 break;
4746
4747 case RQ_RValue:
4748 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4749 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004750 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004751 ImplicitParamType);
4752 return ICS;
4753 }
4754 break;
4755 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004756
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004757 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004758 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004759 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4760 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004761 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004762 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004763 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4764 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004765 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004766 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004767 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4768 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4769 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004770 return ICS;
4771}
4772
4773/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4774/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4775/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004776ExprResult
4777Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004778 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004779 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004780 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004781 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004782 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004783 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004784
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004785 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004786 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004787 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4788 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004789 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004790 } else {
4791 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4792 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004793 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004794 }
4795
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004796 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4797 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004798 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004799 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4800 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004801 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4802 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4803 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4804 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4805 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4806 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004807 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004808 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4809 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4810 << From->getSourceRange();
4811 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4812 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004813 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004814 }
4815 }
4816
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004817 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004818 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004819 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004820 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004821
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004822 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4823 ExprResult FromRes =
4824 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4825 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4826 return ExprError();
4827 From = FromRes.take();
4828 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004829
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004830 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004831 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004832 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004833 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004834}
4835
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004836/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4837/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004838static ImplicitConversionSequence
4839TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004840 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004841 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004842 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4843 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004844 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004845 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004846 /*CStyle=*/false,
4847 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004848}
4849
4850/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4851/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004852ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004853 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4854 return ExprError();
4855
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004856 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004857 if (!ICS.isBad())
4858 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004859
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004860 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004861 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004862 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004863 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004864 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004865}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004866
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004867/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4868/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4869/// is acceptable.
4870static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4871 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4872 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4873 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4874 // conversions are fine.
4875 switch (SCS.Second) {
4876 case ICK_Identity:
4877 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4878 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004879 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004880 return true;
4881
4882 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004883 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4884 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4885 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4886 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4887 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4888
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004889 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4890 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4891 return false;
4892
4893 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4894 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4895 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4896 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4897 case ICK_Qualification:
4898 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4899 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4900 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4901 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4902 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4903 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4904 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4905 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4906 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4907 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4908 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4909 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4910 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4911 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4912
4913 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4914 break;
4915 }
4916
4917 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4918}
4919
4920/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4921/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4922/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4923ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4924 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4925 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004926 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004927 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4928
4929 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4930 return ExprError();
4931
4932 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4933 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4934 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4935 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4936 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4937 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4938 // narrowing conversions.
4939 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4940 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4941 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4942 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4943 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4944 /*CStyle=*/false,
4945 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4946 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4947 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4948 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4949 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004950 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004951 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4952 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4953 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4954 break;
4955 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4956 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4957 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4958 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004959 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004960 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4961 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4962 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4963 break;
4964 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4965 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4966 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004967 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004968 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4969 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4970 return ExprError();
4971
4972 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4973 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4974 }
4975
4976 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4977 if (Result.isInvalid())
4978 return Result;
4979
4980 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4981 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004982 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004983 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
4984 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004985 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4986 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4987 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4988 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4989 break;
4990
4991 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004992 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4993 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4994 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004995 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004996 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004997 break;
4998
4999 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00005000 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5001 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
5002 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005003 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5004 break;
5005 }
5006
5007 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005008 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005009 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5010 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5011
5012 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
5013 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5014 // the AST.
5015 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005016 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005017 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005018
5019 if (Notes.empty()) {
5020 // It's a constant expression.
5021 return Result;
5022 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005023 }
5024
5025 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5026 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5027 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5028 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5029 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005030 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005031 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5032 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5033 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5034 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005035 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005036}
5037
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005038/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5039/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5040/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5041static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5042 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5043 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5044 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5045 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5046 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005047}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005048
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005049/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5050/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5051static ImplicitConversionSequence
5052TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5053 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5054 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5055 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5056 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5057 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5058 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5059 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5060 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5061 /*CStyle=*/false,
5062 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
5063
5064 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5065 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5066 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5067 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5068 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5069 break;
5070
5071 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5072 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5073 break;
5074
5075 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5076 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5077 break;
5078 }
5079
5080 return ICS;
5081}
5082
5083/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5084/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5085ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005086 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5087 return ExprError();
5088
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005089 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005090 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5091 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005092 if (!ICS.isBad())
5093 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005094 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005095}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005096
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005097/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5098/// type of a permitted flavor.
5099static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
5100 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5101 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5102}
5103
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005104/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005105/// enumeration type.
5106///
5107/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
5108/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
5109/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5110///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005111/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5112/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005113///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005114/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005115///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005116/// \param Diagnoser Used to output any diagnostics.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005117///
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005118/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
5119/// enumerations should be considered.
5120///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005121/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5122/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005123ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005124Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005125 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005126 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005127 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5128 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005129 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005130
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005131 // Process placeholders immediately.
5132 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5133 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5134 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
5135 From = result.take();
5136 }
5137
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005138 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
5139 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005140 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005141 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005142
5143 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5144
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005145 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005146 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
5147 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005148 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005149 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
5150 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005151 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005152 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005153
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005154 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005155 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005156 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser;
5157 Expr *From;
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005158
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005159 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, Expr *From)
5160 : TypeDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress), Diagnoser(Diagnoser), From(From) {}
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005161
5162 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005163 Diagnoser.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005164 }
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005165 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Diagnoser, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005166
5167 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005168 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005169
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005170 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5171 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
5172 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005173 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
5174 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005175 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005176
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005177 bool HadMultipleCandidates
5178 = (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005179
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005180 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
5181 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005182 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005183 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
5184 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
5185 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
5186 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005187 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
5188 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5189 else
5190 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5191 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005192 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005193 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005194
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005195 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5196 case 0:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005197 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005198 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5199 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5200 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005201
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005202 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5203 // conversion; use it.
5204 QualType ConvTy
5205 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5206 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor8987b232011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005207 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005208
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005209 Diagnoser.diagnoseExplicitConv(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005210 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5211 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5212 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5213 ")");
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005214 Diagnoser.noteExplicitConv(*this, Conversion, ConvTy);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005215
5216 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005217 // explicit conversion function.
5218 if (isSFINAEContext())
5219 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005220
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005221 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005222 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5223 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005224 if (Result.isInvalid())
5225 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005226 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5227 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5228 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5229 Result.get(), 0,
5230 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005231 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005232
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005233 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5234 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005235
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005236 case 1: {
5237 // Apply this conversion.
5238 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5239 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005240
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005241 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5242 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5243 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005244 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005245 if (!Diagnoser.SuppressConversion) {
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005246 if (isSFINAEContext())
5247 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005248
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005249 Diagnoser.diagnoseConversion(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5250 << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005251 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005252
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005253 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5254 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005255 if (Result.isInvalid())
5256 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005257 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5258 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5259 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5260 Result.get(), 0,
5261 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005262 break;
5263 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005264
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005265 default:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005266 if (Diagnoser.Suppress)
5267 return ExprError();
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005268
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005269 Diagnoser.diagnoseAmbiguous(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005270 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5271 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5272 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5273 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005274 Diagnoser.noteAmbiguous(*this, Conv, ConvTy);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005275 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005276 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005277 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005278
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005279 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005280 !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
5281 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, From->getType())
5282 << From->getSourceRange();
5283 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005284
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005285 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005286}
5287
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005288/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005289/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5290/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5291/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005292///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005293/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005294/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5295/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005296void
5297Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005298 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005299 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005300 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005301 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005302 bool PartialOverloading,
5303 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005304 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005305 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005306 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005307 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005308 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005309
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005310 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005311 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5312 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5313 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5314 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5315 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005316 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5317 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5318 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005319 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005320 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005321 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005322 return;
5323 }
5324 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5325 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005326 }
5327
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005328 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005329 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005330
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005331 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005332 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005333
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005334 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5335 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5336 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5337 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5338 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005339 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005340 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005341 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5342 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005343 return;
5344 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005345
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005346 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005347 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005348 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005349 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005350 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005351 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005352 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005353 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005354
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005355 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5356
5357 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5358 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5359 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005360 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005361 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005362 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005363 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005364 return;
5365 }
5366
5367 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5368 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5369 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5370 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5371 // exactly m parameters.
5372 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005373 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005374 // Not enough arguments.
5375 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005376 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005377 return;
5378 }
5379
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005380 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005381 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005382 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5383 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5384 Candidate.Viable = false;
5385 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5386 return;
5387 }
5388
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005389 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5390 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005391 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005392 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5393 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5394 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5395 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5396 // parameter of F.
5397 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005398 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005399 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005400 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005401 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5402 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005403 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005404 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005405 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5406 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005407 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005408 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005409 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005410 } else {
5411 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5412 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5413 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005414 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005415 }
5416 }
5417}
5418
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005419/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5420/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005421void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005422 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005423 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005424 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5425 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005426 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005427 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5428 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005429 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005430 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005431 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005432 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005433 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5434 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005435 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005436 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005437 SuppressUserConversions);
5438 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005439 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005440 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5441 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005442 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005443 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005444 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005445 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005446 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5447 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005448 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005449 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005450 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005451 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005452 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005453 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005454}
5455
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005456/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5457/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005458void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005459 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005460 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005461 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5462 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005463 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005464 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005465 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005466
5467 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5468 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005469
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005470 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5471 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5472 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005473 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5474 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005475 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5476 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005477 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005478 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005479 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005480 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5481 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005482 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005483 }
5484}
5485
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005486/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5487/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5488/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5489/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5490/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5491/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005492/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005493void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005494Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005495 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005496 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005497 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005498 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005499 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005500 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005501 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005502 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005503 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5504 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005505
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005506 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5507 return;
5508
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005509 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005510 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005511
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005512 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005513 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005514 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005515 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005516 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005517 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005518 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005519
5520 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5521
5522 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5523 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5524 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005525 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005526 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005527 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005528 return;
5529 }
5530
5531 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5532 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5533 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5534 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5535 // exactly m parameters.
5536 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005537 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005538 // Not enough arguments.
5539 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005540 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005541 return;
5542 }
5543
5544 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005545
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005546 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005547 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5548 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5549 else {
5550 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5551 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005552 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005553 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5554 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005555 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005556 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005557 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005558 return;
5559 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005560 }
5561
5562 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5563 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005564 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005565 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5566 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5567 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5568 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5569 // parameter of F.
5570 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005571 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005572 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005573 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005574 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5575 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005576 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005577 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005578 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005579 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005580 break;
5581 }
5582 } else {
5583 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5584 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5585 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005586 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005587 }
5588 }
5589}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005590
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005591/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5592/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5593/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005594void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005595Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005596 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005597 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005598 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005599 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005600 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005601 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005602 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005603 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005604 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5605 return;
5606
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005607 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005608 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005609 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005610 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005611 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5612 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5613 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5614 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5615 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005616 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005617 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5618 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005619 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5620 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005621 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005622 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5623 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5624 Candidate.Viable = false;
5625 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5626 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5627 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005628 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005629 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005630 Info);
5631 return;
5632 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005633
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005634 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5635 // deduction as a candidate.
5636 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005637 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005638 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005639 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005640 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5641 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005642}
5643
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005644/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5645/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5646/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005647void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005648Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005649 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005650 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005651 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005652 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005653 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005654 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5655 return;
5656
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005657 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005658 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005659 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005660 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005661 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5662 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5663 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5664 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5665 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005666 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005667 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5668 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005669 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5670 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005671 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005672 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005673 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5674 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005675 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005676 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5677 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005678 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005679 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005680 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005681 return;
5682 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005683
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005684 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5685 // deduction as a candidate.
5686 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005687 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005688 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005689}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005691/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005692/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005693/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005694/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005695/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5696/// conversion function produces).
5697void
5698Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005699 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005700 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005701 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5702 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005703 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5704 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005705 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005706 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5707 return;
5708
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005709 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005710 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005711
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005712 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005713 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005714 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005715 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005716 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005717 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005718 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005719 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005720 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005721 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005722 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005723
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005724 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005725 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5726 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005727 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005728 //
5729 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5730 // object parameter.
5731 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5732 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5733 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5734 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5735 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005736
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005737 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005738 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5739 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005740 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005741
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005742 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005743 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005744 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005745 return;
5746 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005747
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005748 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005749 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5750 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5751 QualType FromCanon
5752 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5753 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5754 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5755 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005756 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005757 return;
5758 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005759
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005760 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5761 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5762 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5763 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5764 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5765 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5766 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5767 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005768 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005769 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005770 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5771 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005772 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005773 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005774
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005775 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5776 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005777 Candidate.Viable = false;
5778 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5779 return;
5780 }
5781
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005782 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005783
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005784 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005785 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5786 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005787 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00005788 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, MultiExprArg(), CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005789 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005790 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005791 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005792 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005793 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5794 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005795
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005796 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005797 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5798 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005799
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005800 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5801 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005802 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005803 // shall have exact match rank.
5804 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5805 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5806 Candidate.Viable = false;
5807 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5808 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005809
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005810 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5811 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5812 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5813 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5814 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005815 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005816 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5817 Candidate.Viable = false;
5818 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5819 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005820 break;
5821
5822 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5823 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005824 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005825 break;
5826
5827 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005828 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005829 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5830 }
5831}
5832
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005833/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5834/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5835/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5836/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5837/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005838void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005839Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005840 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005841 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005842 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5843 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5844 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5845 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5846
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005847 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5848 return;
5849
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005850 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005851 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5852 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005853 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005854 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005855 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005856 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5857 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5858 Candidate.Viable = false;
5859 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5860 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5861 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005862 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005863 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005864 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005865 return;
5866 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005867
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005868 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5869 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5870 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005871 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005872 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005873}
5874
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005875/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5876/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5877/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5878/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5879/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5880void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005881 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005882 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005883 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005884 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005885 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005886 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005887 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5888 return;
5889
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005890 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005891 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005892
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005893 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005894 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005895 Candidate.Function = 0;
5896 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5897 Candidate.Viable = true;
5898 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005899 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005900 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005901
5902 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5903 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005904 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005905 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005906 Object->Classify(Context),
5907 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005908 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005909 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005910 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005911 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005912 return;
5913 }
5914
5915 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5916 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5917 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005918 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005919 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005920 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005921 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005922 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005923 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005924 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005925 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5926 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5927
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005928 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005929 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5930
5931 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5932 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5933 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005934 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005935 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005936 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005937 return;
5938 }
5939
5940 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5941 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005942 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005943 // Not enough arguments.
5944 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005945 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005946 return;
5947 }
5948
5949 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5950 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005951 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005952 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5953 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5954 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5955 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5956 // parameter of F.
5957 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005958 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005959 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005960 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005961 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5962 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005963 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005964 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005965 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005966 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005967 break;
5968 }
5969 } else {
5970 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5971 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5972 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005973 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005974 }
5975 }
5976}
5977
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005978/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5979/// member functions.
5980///
5981/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5982/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5983/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5984/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5985/// [over.match.oper]).
5986void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5987 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5988 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5989 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5990 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005991 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5992
5993 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5994 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5995 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5996 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5997 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5998 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5999 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6000 // constructed as follows:
6001 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006002
6003 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
6004 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
6005 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
6006 // empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006007 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006008 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00006009 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0))
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006010 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006011
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006012 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6013 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6014 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6015
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006016 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006017 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6018 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006019 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006020 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006021 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006022 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006023 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006024 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006025}
6026
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006027/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6028/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6029/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006030/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6031/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006032/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6033/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6034/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006035void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006036 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006037 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006038 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6039 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006040 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006041 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006042
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006043 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006044 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006045 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006046 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006047 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006048 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006049 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
6050 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6051 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6052
6053 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6054 // arguments.
6055 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006056 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006057 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006058 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6059 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6060 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6061 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6062 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6063 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006064 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006065 //
6066 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6067 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6068 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6069 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006070 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006071 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006072 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006073 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6074 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006075 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006076 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006077 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006078 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006079 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6080 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006081 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006082 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006083 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006084 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006085 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006086 break;
6087 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006088 }
6089}
6090
6091/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6092/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6093/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6094/// enumeration types.
6095class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6096 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006097 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006098
6099 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6100 /// built-in candidates.
6101 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6102
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006103 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6104 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6105 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6106
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006107 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6108 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6109 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6110
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006111 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006112 /// candidates.
6113 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006114
6115 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6116 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6117
6118 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6119 /// were present in the candidate set.
6120 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6121
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006122 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6123 /// candidate set.
6124 bool HasNullPtrType;
6125
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006126 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6127 /// candidate type set.
6128 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006129
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006130 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6131 ASTContext &Context;
6132
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006133 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6134 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006135 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006136
6137public:
6138 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006139 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006140
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006141 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006142 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6143 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006144 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006145 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6146 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006147
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006148 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006149 SourceLocation Loc,
6150 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006151 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6152 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006153
6154 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6155 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6156
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006157 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006158 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6159
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006160 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6161 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6162
6163 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6164 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6165
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006166 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6167 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6168
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006169 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006170 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006171
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006172 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6173 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006174
6175 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6176 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006177 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006178};
6179
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006180/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006181/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6182/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6183/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6184/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6185/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6186/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006187///
6188/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006189bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006190BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6191 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006192
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006193 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006194 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006195 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006196
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006197 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006198 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006199 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006200 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006201 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6202 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6203 buildObjCPtr = true;
6204 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006205 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006206 }
6207
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006208 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6209 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6210 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6211 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6212 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6213 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006214
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006215 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006216 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6217 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006218
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006219 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6220 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6221 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006222 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006223 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006224
6225 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6226 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6227 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6228 (!hasRestrict ||
6229 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6230 continue;
6231
6232 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006233 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006234
6235 // Build qualified pointer type.
6236 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006237 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006238 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006239 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006240 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6241
6242 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6243 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006244 }
6245
6246 return true;
6247}
6248
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006249/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6250/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6251/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6252/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6253/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6254/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6255/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006256///
6257/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006258bool
6259BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6260 QualType Ty) {
6261 // Insert this type.
6262 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6263 return false;
6264
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006265 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6266 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006267
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006268 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006269 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6270 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6271 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6272 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6273 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6274 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006275 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6276
6277 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6278 // qualifiers.
6279 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6280 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6281 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006282
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006283 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006284 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6285 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006286 }
6287
6288 return true;
6289}
6290
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006291/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6292/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006293/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6294/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006295/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6296/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6297/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6298/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006299void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006300BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006301 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006302 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006303 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6304 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006305 // Only deal with canonical types.
6306 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6307
6308 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6309 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006310 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006311 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6312
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006313 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6314 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6315 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6316
6317 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006318 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006319
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006320 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6321 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6322 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6323
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006324 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6325 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6326 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6327
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006328 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6329 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6330 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006331 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6332 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006333 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006334 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006335 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6336 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6337 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6338 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006339 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006340 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006341 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006342 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006343 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6344 // extension.
6345 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006346 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006347 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6348 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006349 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6350 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6351 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6352 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006353
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006354 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006355 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6356 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6357 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6358 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6359 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006360 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6361 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6362 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006363
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006364 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6365 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6366 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6367 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006368
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006369 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6370 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6371 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6372 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006373 }
6374 }
6375 }
6376}
6377
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006378/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6379/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6380/// given type to the candidate set.
6381static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6382 QualType T,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006383 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006384 unsigned NumArgs,
6385 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6386 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006387
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006388 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6389 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6390 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6391 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6392 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006393
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006394 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6395 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006396 ParamTypes[0]
6397 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006398 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6399 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006400 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006401 }
6402}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006403
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006404/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6405/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006406static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6407 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6408 const RecordType *TyRec;
6409 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6410 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006411 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006412 else
6413 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6414 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006415 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006416 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6417 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6418 return VRQuals;
6419 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006420
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006421 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006422 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6423 return VRQuals;
6424
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006425 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6426 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6427 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006428
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006429 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6430 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006431 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6432 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6433 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6434 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006435 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6436 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6437 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6438 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6439 // as see them.
6440 bool done = false;
6441 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006442 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6443 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006444 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6445 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006446 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006447 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6448 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6449 else
6450 done = true;
6451 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6452 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006453 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6454 return VRQuals;
6455 }
6456 }
6457 }
6458 return VRQuals;
6459}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006460
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006461namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006462
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006463/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6464/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6465/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6466/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6467class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006468 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6469 Sema &S;
6470 Expr **Args;
6471 unsigned NumArgs;
6472 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006473 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006474 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006475 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006476
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006477 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6478 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006479 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6480 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006481 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006482 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006483 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006484 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006485 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006486 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6487 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006488
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006489 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6490 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6491 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6492 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6493 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6494 // Start of promoted types.
6495 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6496 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6497 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006498
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006499 // Start of integral types.
6500 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6501 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6502 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006503 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006504 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6505 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6506 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006507 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006508 // End of promoted types.
6509
6510 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6511 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6512 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6513 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6514 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6515 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6516 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6517 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6518 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6519 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006520 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006521 };
6522 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6523 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006524
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006525 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6526 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6527 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6528 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6529 // The rules are basically:
6530 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6531 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6532 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6533 // - use the larger type
6534 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6535 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6536 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6537 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6538 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006539 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006540 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006541 Dep=-1,
6542 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006543 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006544 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006545 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006546/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6547/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6548/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6549/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6550/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6551/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6552/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6553/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6554/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6555/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6556/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006557 };
6558
6559 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6560 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6561 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6562
6563 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006564 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006565
6566 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6567 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006568 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6569 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006570 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6571 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6572
6573 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6574 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6575 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6576
6577 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6578 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6579 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6580 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6581 }
6582
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006583 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6584 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006585 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006586 bool HasVolatile,
6587 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006588 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6589 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6590 S.Context.IntTy
6591 };
6592
6593 // Non-volatile version.
6594 if (NumArgs == 1)
6595 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6596 else
6597 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6598
6599 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6600 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6601 if (HasVolatile) {
6602 ParamTypes[0] =
6603 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6604 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6605 if (NumArgs == 1)
6606 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6607 else
6608 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6609 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006610
6611 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6612 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6613 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6614 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6615 ParamTypes[0]
6616 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6617 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
6618 if (NumArgs == 1)
6619 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6620 else
6621 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6622
6623 if (HasVolatile) {
6624 ParamTypes[0]
6625 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6626 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6627 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6628 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
6629 if (NumArgs == 1)
6630 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1,
6631 CandidateSet);
6632 else
6633 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6634 }
6635 }
6636
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006637 }
6638
6639public:
6640 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6641 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6642 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006643 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006644 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006645 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6646 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6647 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006648 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6649 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006650 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6651 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6652 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006653 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006654 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006655 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006656 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006657 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006658 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6659 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006660 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006661 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006662 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006663 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6664 }
6665
6666 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6667 //
6668 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6669 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6670 // functions of the form
6671 //
6672 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6673 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6674 //
6675 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6676 //
6677 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6678 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6679 // candidate operator functions of the form
6680 //
6681 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6682 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6683 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006684 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6685 return;
6686
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006687 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6688 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6689 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006690 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006691 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6692 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006693 }
6694 }
6695
6696 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6697 //
6698 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6699 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6700 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6701 //
6702 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6703 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6704 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6705 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6706 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6707 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6708 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6709 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6710 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6711 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006712 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006713 continue;
6714
6715 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006716 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6717 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6718 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6719 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006720 }
6721 }
6722
6723 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6724 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6725 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6726 //
6727 // T& operator*(T*);
6728 //
6729 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006730 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006731 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006732 // T& operator*(T*);
6733 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6734 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6735 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6736 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6737 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6738 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6739 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006740 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6741 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006742
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006743 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6744 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6745 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006746
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006747 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6748 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6749 }
6750 }
6751
6752 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6753 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6754 // operator functions of the form
6755 //
6756 // T operator+(T);
6757 // T operator-(T);
6758 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006759 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6760 return;
6761
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006762 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6763 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006764 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006765 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6766 }
6767
6768 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6769 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6770 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6771 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6772 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6773 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6774 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6775 }
6776 }
6777
6778 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6779 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6780 // the form
6781 //
6782 // T* operator+(T*);
6783 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6784 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6785 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6786 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6787 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6788 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6789 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6790 }
6791 }
6792
6793 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6794 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6795 // operator functions of the form
6796 //
6797 // T operator~(T);
6798 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006799 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6800 return;
6801
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006802 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6803 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006804 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006805 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6806 }
6807
6808 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6809 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6810 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6811 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6812 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6813 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6814 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6815 }
6816 }
6817
6818 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6819 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6820 // functions of the form
6821 //
6822 // bool operator==(T,T);
6823 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6824 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6825 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6826 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6827
6828 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6829 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6830 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6831 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6832 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6833 ++MemPtr) {
6834 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6835 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6836 continue;
6837
6838 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6839 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6840 CandidateSet);
6841 }
6842 }
6843 }
6844
6845 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6846 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006847 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6848 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006849 //
6850 // bool operator<(T, T);
6851 // bool operator>(T, T);
6852 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6853 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6854 // bool operator==(T, T);
6855 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006856 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006857 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6858 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
6859 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
6860 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
6861 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006862 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006863 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
6864 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
6865 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
6866 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006867 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6868 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6869 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6870 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6871
6872 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6873 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6874 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6875 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6876 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6877 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6878 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6879 continue;
6880
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006881 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
6882 continue;
6883
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006884 QualType FirstParamType =
6885 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6886 QualType SecondParamType =
6887 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6888
6889 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6890 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6891 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6892 continue;
6893
6894 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6895 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6896 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6897 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6898 }
6899 }
6900 }
6901
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006902 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6903 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6904
6905 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6906 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6907 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6908 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6909 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6910 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6911 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6912 continue;
6913
6914 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6915 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6916 CandidateSet);
6917 }
6918 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6919 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6920 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6921 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6922 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6923
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006924 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6925 // candidate exists.
6926 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6927 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6928 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006929 continue;
6930
6931 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006932 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6933 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006934 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006935
6936 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6937 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6938 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6939 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6940 NullPtrTy))) {
6941 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6942 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6943 CandidateSet);
6944 }
6945 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006946 }
6947 }
6948
6949 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6950 //
6951 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6952 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6953 //
6954 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6955 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6956 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6957 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6958 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6959 //
6960 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6961 //
6962 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6963 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6964 //
6965 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6966 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6967 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6968 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6969
6970 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6971 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6972 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6973 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6974 };
6975 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6976 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6977 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6978 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006979 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6980 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6981 continue;
6982
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006983 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6984 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6985 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6986 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6987 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6988 CandidateSet);
6989 }
6990 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6991 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6992 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6993 continue;
6994
6995 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6996 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6997 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6998 }
6999 }
7000 }
7001 }
7002
7003 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7004 //
7005 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7006 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7007 //
7008 // LR operator*(L, R);
7009 // LR operator/(L, R);
7010 // LR operator+(L, R);
7011 // LR operator-(L, R);
7012 // bool operator<(L, R);
7013 // bool operator>(L, R);
7014 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7015 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7016 // bool operator==(L, R);
7017 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7018 //
7019 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7020 // between types L and R.
7021 //
7022 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7023 //
7024 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7025 // candidate operator functions of the form
7026 //
7027 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7028 //
7029 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7030 // between types L and R.
7031 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7032 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007033 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7034 return;
7035
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007036 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7037 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7038 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7039 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007040 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7041 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007042 QualType Result =
7043 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007044 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007045 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7046 }
7047 }
7048
7049 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7050 // conditional operator for vector types.
7051 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7052 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7053 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7054 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7055 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7056 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7057 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7058 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7059 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7060 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7061 if (!isComparison) {
7062 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7063 Result = *Vec1;
7064 else
7065 Result = *Vec2;
7066 }
7067
7068 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7069 }
7070 }
7071 }
7072
7073 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7074 //
7075 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7076 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7077 //
7078 // LR operator%(L, R);
7079 // LR operator&(L, R);
7080 // LR operator^(L, R);
7081 // LR operator|(L, R);
7082 // L operator<<(L, R);
7083 // L operator>>(L, R);
7084 //
7085 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7086 // between types L and R.
7087 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007088 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7089 return;
7090
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007091 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7092 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7093 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7094 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007095 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7096 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007097 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7098 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007099 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007100 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7101 }
7102 }
7103 }
7104
7105 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7106 //
7107 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7108 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7109 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7110 //
7111 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7112 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7113 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7114 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7115
7116 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7117 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7118 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7119 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7120 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7121 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7122 continue;
7123
7124 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
7125 CandidateSet);
7126 }
7127
7128 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7129 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7130 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7131 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7132 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7133 continue;
7134
7135 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
7136 CandidateSet);
7137 }
7138 }
7139 }
7140
7141 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7142 //
7143 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7144 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7145 // of the form
7146 //
7147 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7148 //
7149 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7150 //
7151 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7152 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7153 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7154 //
7155 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7156 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7157 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7158 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7159 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7160
7161 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7162 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7163 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7164 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7165 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7166 if (isEqualOp)
7167 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007168 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7169 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007170
7171 // non-volatile version
7172 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7173 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7174 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7175 };
7176 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7177 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7178
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007179 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7180 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7181 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007182 // volatile version
7183 ParamTypes[0] =
7184 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7185 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7186 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7187 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007188
7189 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7190 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7191 // restrict version
7192 ParamTypes[0]
7193 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7194 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7195 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7196
7197 if (NeedVolatile) {
7198 // volatile restrict version
7199 ParamTypes[0]
7200 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7201 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7202 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7203 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7204 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7205 CandidateSet,
7206 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7207 }
7208 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007209 }
7210
7211 if (isEqualOp) {
7212 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7213 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7214 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7215 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7216 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7217 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7218 continue;
7219
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007220 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7221 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7222 *Ptr,
7223 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007224
7225 // non-volatile version
7226 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7227 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7228
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007229 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7230 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7231 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007232 // volatile version
7233 ParamTypes[0] =
7234 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007235 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7236 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007237 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007238
7239 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7240 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7241 // restrict version
7242 ParamTypes[0]
7243 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7244 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7245 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7246
7247 if (NeedVolatile) {
7248 // volatile restrict version
7249 ParamTypes[0]
7250 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7251 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7252 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7253 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7254 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7255 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7256
7257 }
7258 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007259 }
7260 }
7261 }
7262
7263 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7264 //
7265 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7266 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7267 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7268 // the form
7269 //
7270 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7271 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7272 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7273 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7274 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7275 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007276 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7277 return;
7278
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007279 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7280 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7281 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7282 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007283 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007284
7285 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7286 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007287 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007288 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7289 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7290
7291 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7292 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7293 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007294 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007295 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007296 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7297 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007298 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7299 }
7300 }
7301 }
7302
7303 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7304 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7305 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7306 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7307 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7308 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7309 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7310 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7311 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7312 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7313 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7314 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7315 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7316 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7317 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7318
7319 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7320 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7321 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7322 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007323 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7324 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007325 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7326 }
7327 }
7328 }
7329 }
7330
7331 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7332 //
7333 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7334 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7335 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7336 //
7337 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7338 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7339 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7340 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7341 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7342 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7343 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007344 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7345 return;
7346
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007347 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7348 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7349 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7350 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007351 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007352
7353 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7354 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007355 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007356 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7357 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7358 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007359 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007360 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7361 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7362 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7363 CandidateSet);
7364 }
7365 }
7366 }
7367 }
7368
7369 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7370 //
7371 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7372 //
7373 // bool operator!(bool);
7374 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7375 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7376 void addExclaimOverload() {
7377 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7378 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7379 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7380 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7381 }
7382 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7383 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7384 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7385 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7386 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7387 }
7388
7389 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7390 //
7391 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7392 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7393 //
7394 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7395 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7396 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7397 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7398 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7399 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7400 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7401 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7402 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7403 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7404 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7405 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007406 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7407 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007408
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007409 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7410
7411 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7412 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7413 }
7414
7415 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7416 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7417 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7418 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7419 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7420 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007421 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7422 continue;
7423
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007424 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7425
7426 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7427 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7428 }
7429 }
7430
7431 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7432 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7433 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7434 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7435 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7436 //
7437 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7438 //
7439 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7440 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7441 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7442 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7443 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7444 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7445 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7446 QualType C1;
7447 QualifierCollector Q1;
7448 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7449 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7450 continue;
7451 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7452 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7453 // volatile/restrict type.
7454 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7455 continue;
7456 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7457 continue;
7458 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7459 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7460 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7461 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7462 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7463 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7464 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7465 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7466 break;
7467 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7468 // build CV12 T&
7469 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7470 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7471 T.isVolatileQualified())
7472 continue;
7473 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7474 T.isRestrictQualified())
7475 continue;
7476 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7477 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7478 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7479 }
7480 }
7481 }
7482
7483 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7484 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7485 // therefore added as binary.
7486 //
7487 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7488 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7489 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7490 //
7491 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7492 //
7493 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7494 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7495 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7496
7497 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7498 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7499 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7500 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7501 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7502 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7503 continue;
7504
7505 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7506 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7507 }
7508
7509 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7510 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7511 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7512 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7513 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7514 continue;
7515
7516 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7517 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7518 }
7519
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00007520 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007521 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7522 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7523 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7524 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7525 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7526 continue;
7527
7528 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7529 continue;
7530
7531 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7532 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7533 }
7534 }
7535 }
7536 }
7537};
7538
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007539} // end anonymous namespace
7540
7541/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7542/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7543/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7544/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7545/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7546void
7547Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7548 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7549 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7550 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007551 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7552 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007553 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7554 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007555 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7556 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007557 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7558 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007559
7560 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7561 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007562 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007563 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7564 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7565 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7566 OpLoc,
7567 true,
7568 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7569 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7570 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7571 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007572 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7573 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7574 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7575 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7576 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007577 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007578
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007579 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7580 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007581 //
7582 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7583 // 'bool' overloads.
7584 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7585 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007586 return;
7587
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007588 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7589 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7590 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007591 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007592 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7593
7594 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007595 switch (Op) {
7596 case OO_None:
7597 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007598 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007599
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007600 case OO_New:
7601 case OO_Delete:
7602 case OO_Array_New:
7603 case OO_Array_Delete:
7604 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007605 llvm_unreachable(
7606 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007607
7608 case OO_Comma:
7609 case OO_Arrow:
7610 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7611 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7612 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007613 break;
7614
7615 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007616 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007617 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007618 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007619
7620 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007621 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007622 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007623 } else {
7624 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7625 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7626 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007627 break;
7628
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007629 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007630 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007631 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7632 else
7633 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7634 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007635
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007636 case OO_Slash:
7637 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007638 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007639
7640 case OO_PlusPlus:
7641 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007642 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7643 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007644 break;
7645
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007646 case OO_EqualEqual:
7647 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007648 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007649 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007650
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007651 case OO_Less:
7652 case OO_Greater:
7653 case OO_LessEqual:
7654 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007655 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007656 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7657 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007658
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007659 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007660 case OO_Caret:
7661 case OO_Pipe:
7662 case OO_LessLess:
7663 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007664 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007665 break;
7666
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007667 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7668 if (NumArgs == 1)
7669 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7670 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7671 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7672 break;
7673
7674 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7675 break;
7676
7677 case OO_Tilde:
7678 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7679 break;
7680
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007681 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007682 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007683 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007684
7685 case OO_PlusEqual:
7686 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007687 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007688 // Fall through.
7689
7690 case OO_StarEqual:
7691 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007692 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007693 break;
7694
7695 case OO_PercentEqual:
7696 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7697 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7698 case OO_AmpEqual:
7699 case OO_CaretEqual:
7700 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007701 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007702 break;
7703
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007704 case OO_Exclaim:
7705 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007706 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007707
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007708 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007709 case OO_PipePipe:
7710 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007711 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007712
7713 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007714 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007715 break;
7716
7717 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007718 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007719 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007720
7721 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007722 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007723 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7724 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007725 }
7726}
7727
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007728/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7729/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7730///
7731/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7732/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7733/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7734/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007735void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007736Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007737 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00007738 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007739 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007740 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007741 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007742 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007743
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007744 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7745 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7746 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7747 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7748 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7749 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7750
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007751 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007752 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007753
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007754 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007755 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7756 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7757 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007758 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007759 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007760 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007761 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007762 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007763
7764 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7765 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007766 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007767 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007768 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007769 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007770 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007771
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007772 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7773 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007774 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007775 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007776 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007777 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007778 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007779}
7780
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007781/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7782/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007783bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007784isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007785 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7786 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007787 SourceLocation Loc,
7788 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007789 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7790 // functions.
7791 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7792 return Cand1.Viable;
7793 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7794 return false;
7795
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007796 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7797 //
7798 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7799 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7800 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7801 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7802 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7803 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7804 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007805
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007806 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007807 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7808 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007809 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007810 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7811 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007812 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007813 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007814 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7815 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007816 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7817 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7818 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7819 HasBetterConversion = true;
7820 break;
7821
7822 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7823 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7824 return false;
7825
7826 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7827 // Do nothing.
7828 break;
7829 }
7830 }
7831
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007832 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007833 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007834 if (HasBetterConversion)
7835 return true;
7836
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007837 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007838 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007839 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007840 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7841 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007842
7843 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7844 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7845 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007846 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007847 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007848 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007849 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007850 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7851 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7852 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007853 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007854 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007855 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007856 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007857 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007858
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007859 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7860 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7861 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7862 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7863 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7864 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007865 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007866 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007867 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007868 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7869 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7870 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7871 // pointer or block.
7872 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7873 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7874 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7875 return FuncResult;
7876
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007877 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7878 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007879 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7880 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7881 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7882 return true;
7883
7884 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7885 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7886 return false;
7887
7888 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7889 // Do nothing
7890 break;
7891 }
7892 }
7893
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007894 return false;
7895}
7896
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007897/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007898/// within an overload candidate set.
7899///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007900/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007901/// which overload resolution occurs.
7902///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007903/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
7904/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007905///
7906/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007907OverloadingResult
7908OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007909 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007910 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007911 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007912 Best = end();
7913 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7914 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007915 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007916 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007917 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007918 }
7919
7920 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007921 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007922 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7923
7924 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7925 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007926 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007927 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007928 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007929 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007930 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007931 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007932 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007933 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007934 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007935
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007936 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007937 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007938 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7939 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007940 return OR_Deleted;
7941
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007942 return OR_Success;
7943}
7944
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007945namespace {
7946
7947enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7948 oc_function,
7949 oc_method,
7950 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007951 oc_function_template,
7952 oc_method_template,
7953 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007954 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7955 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007956 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007957 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007958 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007959 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007960};
7961
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007962OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7963 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7964 std::string &Description) {
7965 bool isTemplate = false;
7966
7967 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7968 isTemplate = true;
7969 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7970 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7971 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007972
7973 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007974 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007975 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007976
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007977 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7978 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7979
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007980 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7981 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7982
7983 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7984 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7985
7986 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7987 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7988 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007989 }
7990
7991 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7992 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7993 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007994 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007995 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007996
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007997 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7998 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7999
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00008000 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8001 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8002
8003 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8004 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008005 }
8006
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008007 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008008}
8009
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008010void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
8011 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8012 if (!Ctor) return;
8013
8014 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8015 if (!Ctor) return;
8016
8017 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8018}
8019
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008020} // end anonymous namespace
8021
8022// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008023void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008024 std::string FnDesc;
8025 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008026 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8027 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8028 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8029 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008030 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008031}
8032
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008033//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8034// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008035void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008036 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8037
8038 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8039 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8040
8041 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8042 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8043 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8044 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8045 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008046 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008047 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8048 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008049 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008050 }
8051 }
8052}
8053
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008054/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8055/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8056/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008057void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8058 Sema &S,
8059 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8060 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8061 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8062 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008063 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8064 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8065 // refactoring here.
8066 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8067 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8068 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8069 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8070 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8071 break;
8072 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008073 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008074 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008075 if (I != E)
8076 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008077}
8078
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008079namespace {
8080
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008081void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8082 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8083 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008084 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8085 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8086
8087 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8088 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8089 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008090 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008091 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008092 if (I == 0)
8093 isObjectArgument = true;
8094 else
8095 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008096 }
8097
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008098 std::string FnDesc;
8099 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8100
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008101 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8102 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8103 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008104
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008105 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008106 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008107 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8108 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8109 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008110 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008111
8112 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8113 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8114 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8115 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008116 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008117 return;
8118 }
8119
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008120 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8121 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008122 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8123 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8124 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8125 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8126 else {
8127 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8128 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8129 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8130 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8131 }
8132
8133 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8134 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008135 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8136 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8137
8138 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8139 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8140 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8141 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8142 << FromTy
8143 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8144 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008145 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008146 return;
8147 }
8148
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008149 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008150 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008151 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8152 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8153 << FromTy
8154 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8155 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8156 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8157 return;
8158 }
8159
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008160 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8161 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8162 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8163 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8164 << FromTy
8165 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8166 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8167 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8168 return;
8169 }
8170
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008171 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8172 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8173
8174 if (isObjectArgument) {
8175 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8176 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8177 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8178 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8179 } else {
8180 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8181 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8182 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8183 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8184 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008185 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008186 return;
8187 }
8188
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008189 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8190 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8191 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8192 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8193 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8194 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8195 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8196 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8197 return;
8198 }
8199
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008200 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8201 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8202 // the failure.
8203 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8204 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8205 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8206 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8207 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8208 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8209 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8210 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008211 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008212 return;
8213 }
8214
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008215 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008216 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008217 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8218 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8219 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8220 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8221 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8222 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008223 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008224 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008225 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008226 }
8227 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8228 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8229 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8230 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8231 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8232 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8233 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8234 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8235 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008236 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8237 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008238 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8239 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8240 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8241 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8242 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8243 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8244 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8245 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008246 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8247 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8248 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8249 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8250 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8251 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008252 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008253 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008254
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008255 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008256 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008257 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008258 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8259 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008260 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008261 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008262 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008263 return;
8264 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008265
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008266 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8267 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8268 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8269 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8270 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8271 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8272 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8273 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8274 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8275 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8276 return;
8277 }
8278 }
8279
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008280 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8281 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8282 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008283 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008284 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8285 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8286
8287 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008288 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8289 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008290 FDiag << *HI;
8291 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8292
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008293 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008294}
8295
8296void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8297 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8298 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8299
8300 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8301 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8302
8303 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008304
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008305 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8306 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8307 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8308 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8309 // Just don't report anything.
8310 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8311 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8312 return;
8313
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008314 // at least / at most / exactly
8315 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8316 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008317 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8318 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8319 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008320 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008321 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008322 mode = 0; // "at least"
8323 else
8324 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8325 modeCount = MinParams;
8326 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008327 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8328 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8329 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008330 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8331 mode = 1; // "at most"
8332 else
8333 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8334 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8335 }
8336
8337 std::string Description;
8338 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8339
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008340 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8341 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8342 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8343 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8344 else
8345 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8346 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8347 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008348 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008349}
8350
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008351/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8352void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008353 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008354 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8355
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008356 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008357 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8358 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8359 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8360 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008361 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8362 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8363 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8364
8365 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008366 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8367 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8368 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008369 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008370 return;
8371 }
8372
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008373 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8374 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8375 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8376
8377 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8378
8379 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8380 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008381 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008382 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008383 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008384 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8385
8386 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8387 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8388 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8389 // done on dependent types).
8390 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8391
8392 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8393 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008394 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008395 return;
8396 }
8397
8398 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008399 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008400 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008401 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008402 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008403 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008404 which = 1;
8405 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008406 which = 2;
8407 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008408
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008409 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008410 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008411 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8412 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008413 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008414 return;
8415 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008416
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008417 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008418 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008419 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008420 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008421 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8422 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8423 else {
8424 int index = 0;
8425 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8426 index = TTP->getIndex();
8427 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8428 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8429 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8430 else
8431 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008432 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008433 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8434 << (index + 1);
8435 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008436 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008437 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008438
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008439 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8440 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8441 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8442 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008443
8444 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8445 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008446 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008447 return;
8448
8449 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008450 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008451 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008452 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8453 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8454 TemplateArgString = " ";
8455 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8456 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8457 }
8458
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008459 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8460 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8461 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8462 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8463 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8464 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8465 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8466 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8467 return;
8468 }
8469
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008470 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8471 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8472 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008473 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008474 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008475 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008476 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8477 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8478 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8479 }
8480
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008481 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008482 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008483 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008484 return;
8485 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008486
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008487 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
8488 OverloadExpr::FindResult R =
8489 OverloadExpr::find(Cand->DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8490 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8491 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
8492 << R.Expression->getName();
8493 return;
8494 }
8495
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008496 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8497 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
8498 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
8499 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8500 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8501 return;
8502
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008503 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8504 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008505 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008506 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008507 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008508 return;
8509 }
8510}
8511
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008512/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8513void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8514 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8515 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8516
8517 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8518 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8519
8520 std::string FnDesc;
8521 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8522
8523 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8524 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8525}
8526
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008527/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8528/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8529///
8530/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8531/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8532/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8533/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8534/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8535/// overload.
8536///
8537/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8538/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8539/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008540void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008541 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008542 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8543
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008544 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008545 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8546 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008547 std::string FnDesc;
8548 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008549
8550 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008551 << FnKind << FnDesc
8552 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008553 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008554 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008555 }
8556
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008557 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8558 if (Cand->Viable) {
8559 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8560 return;
8561 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008562
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008563 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8564 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8565 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8566 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008567
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008568 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008569 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008570
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008571 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8572 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008573 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008574 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008575
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008576 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8577 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008578 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008579 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8580 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008581
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008582 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8583 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8584 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8585 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008586 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008587
8588 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8589 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008590 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008591}
8592
8593void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8594 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8595 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8596 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8597 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8598 bool isLValueReference = false;
8599 bool isRValueReference = false;
8600 bool isPointer = false;
8601 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8602 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8603 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8604 isLValueReference = true;
8605 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8606 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8607 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8608 isRValueReference = true;
8609 }
8610 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8611 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8612 isPointer = true;
8613 }
8614 // Desugar down to a function type.
8615 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8616 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8617 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8618 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8619 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8620
8621 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8622 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008623 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008624}
8625
8626void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008627 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008628 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8629 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008630 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008631 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8632 TypeStr += Opc;
8633 TypeStr += "(";
8634 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008635 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008636 TypeStr += ")";
8637 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8638 } else {
8639 TypeStr += ", ";
8640 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8641 TypeStr += ")";
8642 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8643 }
8644}
8645
8646void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8647 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008648 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008649 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8650 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008651 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8652 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8653
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008654 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008655 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008656 }
8657}
8658
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008659SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8660 if (Cand->Function)
8661 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008662 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008663 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8664 return SourceLocation();
8665}
8666
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008667static unsigned
8668RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008669 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008670 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008671 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008672
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008673 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008674 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8675 return 1;
8676
8677 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8678 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8679 return 2;
8680
8681 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8682 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008683 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008684 return 3;
8685
8686 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8687 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8688 return 4;
8689
8690 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8691 return 5;
8692
8693 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8694 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8695 return 6;
8696 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008697 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008698}
8699
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008700struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8701 Sema &S;
8702 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008703
8704 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8705 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008706 // Fast-path this check.
8707 if (L == R) return false;
8708
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008709 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008710 if (L->Viable) {
8711 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8712
8713 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8714 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8715 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008716 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8717 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008718 } else if (R->Viable)
8719 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008720
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008721 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008722
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008723 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8724 if (!L->Viable) {
8725 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8726 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8727 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8728 return false;
8729 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8730 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8731 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008732
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008733 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8734 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8735 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8736 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8737 return true;
8738
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008739 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8740 // comes first.
8741 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8742 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8743 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8744 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008745 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008746 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8747 return true;
8748 else
8749 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008750 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008751
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008752 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8753 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008754 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008755
8756 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008757 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008758 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008759 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8760 L->Conversions[I],
8761 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008762 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8763 leftBetter++;
8764 break;
8765
8766 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8767 leftBetter--;
8768 break;
8769
8770 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8771 break;
8772 }
8773 }
8774 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8775 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8776
8777 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8778 return false;
8779
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008780 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8781 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8782 return true;
8783
8784 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8785 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008786 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008787 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8788 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008789
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008790 // TODO: others?
8791 }
8792
8793 // Sort everything else by location.
8794 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8795 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8796
8797 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8798 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8799 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8800
8801 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008802 }
8803};
8804
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008805/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008806/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008807void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008808 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008809 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8810
8811 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8812 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8813
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008814 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8815 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008816 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8817 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008818
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008819 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008820 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008821 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008822 while (true) {
8823 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8824 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008825 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008826 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008827 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008828 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008829 }
8830
8831 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8832 return;
8833
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008834 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8835 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8836
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008837 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008838 // operation somehow.
8839 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008840
8841 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8842 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8843
8844 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8845 QualType ConvType
8846 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8847 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8848 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8849 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8850 ArgIdx--;
8851 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8852 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8853 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8854 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8855 ArgIdx--;
8856 } else {
8857 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8858 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8859 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8860 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008861 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8862 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008863 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008864 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8865 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008866 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008867 return;
8868 }
8869
8870 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8871 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8872 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008873 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008874 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008875 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008876 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008877 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8878 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008879 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008880 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8881 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008882 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008883 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008884 else
8885 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8886 }
8887}
8888
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008889} // end anonymous namespace
8890
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008891/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8892/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008893/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008894void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8895 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008896 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008897 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008898 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008899 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8900 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008901 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008902 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8903 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008904 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008905 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008906 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008907 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008908 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8909 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8910 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8911 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008912 }
8913 }
8914
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008915 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008916 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008917
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008918 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008919
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008920 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008921 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008922 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008923 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8924 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008925
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008926 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8927 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8928 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008929 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008930 break;
8931 }
8932 ++CandsShown;
8933
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008934 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008935 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008936 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008937 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008938 else {
8939 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8940 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008941 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8942 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8943 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8944 //
8945 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8946 // different ambiguities, though.
8947 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008948 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008949 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8950 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008951
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008952 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008953 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008954 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008955 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008956
8957 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008958 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008959}
8960
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008961// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8962// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8963// R (A) --> R(A)
8964// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8965// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8966// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8967QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8968 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8969 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8970 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8971 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8972 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8973 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8974 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008975 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008976 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8977 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8978 Ret =
8979 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8980 return Ret;
8981}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008982
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008983// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8984// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8985class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8986{
8987 Sema& S;
8988 Expr* SourceExpr;
8989 const QualType& TargetType;
8990 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8991
8992 bool Complain;
8993 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8994 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008995
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008996 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8997 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008998
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008999 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9000 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9001 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009002 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009003
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009004public:
9005 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
9006 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
9007 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9008 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9009 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9010 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9011 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
9012 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9013 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
9014 {
9015 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
9016
9017 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9018 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9019 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009020 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009021 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009022
9023 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9024 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9025 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
9026 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
9027 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9028 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
9029
9030 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9031 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9032 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9033 return;
9034 }
9035 }
9036
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009037 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
9038 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009039 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009040 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009041 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009042
9043 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9044 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009045
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009046 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9047 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9048 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9049 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9050 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9051 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9052 else
9053 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9054 }
9055 }
9056 }
9057
9058private:
9059 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9060 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9061 }
9062
9063 // [ToType] [Return]
9064
9065 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9066 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9067 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9068 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9069 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9070 }
9071
9072 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9073 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9074 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9075 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9076 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9077 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9078 // static when converting to member pointer.
9079 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9080 return false;
9081 }
9082 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9083 return false;
9084
9085 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9086 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9087 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9088 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9089 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9090 // overloaded functions considered.
9091 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009092 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009093 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9094 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9095 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9096 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
9097 Info)) {
9098 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9099 (void)Result;
9100 return false;
9101 }
9102
9103 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
9104 // This function template specicalization works.
9105 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
9106 assert(TargetFunctionType
9107 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
9108 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9109 return true;
9110 }
9111
9112 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9113 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009114 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009115 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9116 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009117 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9118 return false;
9119 }
9120 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9121 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009122
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009123 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009124 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009125 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9126 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9127 return false;
9128
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009129 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009130 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9131 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009132 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9133 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009134 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9135 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009136 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009137 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009138 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009139 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009140
9141 return false;
9142 }
9143
9144 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9145 bool Ret = false;
9146
9147 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9148 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9149 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9150 return false;
9151
9152 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9153 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9154 I != E; ++I) {
9155 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9156 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9157
9158 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9159 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9160 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9161 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9162 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9163 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9164 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9165 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9166 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9167 Ret = true;
9168 }
9169 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9170 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9171 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9172 Ret = true;
9173 }
9174 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9175 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009176 }
9177
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009178 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009179 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9180 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9181 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9182 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9183 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9184
9185 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9186 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9187 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9188 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009189
9190 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9191 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9192 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009193
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009194 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009195 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
9196 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
9197 S.PDiag(),
9198 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9199 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
9200 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9201 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009202 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009203
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009204 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9205 // Make it the first and only element
9206 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9207 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9208 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009209 }
9210 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009211
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009212 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9213 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9214 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9215 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9216 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9217 ++I;
9218 else {
9219 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9220 Matches.set_size(N);
9221 }
9222 }
9223 }
9224
9225public:
9226 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9227 assert(Matches.empty());
9228 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9229 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9230 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009231 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009232 }
9233
9234 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9235 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9236 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9237 }
9238
9239 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9240 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9241 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9242 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9243 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9244 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9245 }
9246
9247 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9248 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9249 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9250 }
9251
9252 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9253 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9254 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9255 << OvlExpr->getName()
9256 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009257 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009258 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009259
9260 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9261
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009262 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9263
9264 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9265 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9266 return Matches[0].second;
9267 }
9268
9269 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9270 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9271 return &Matches[0].first;
9272 }
9273};
9274
9275/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9276/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9277/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9278/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9279///
9280/// @code
9281/// int f(double);
9282/// int f(int);
9283///
9284/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9285/// @endcode
9286///
9287/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9288/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9289/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9290FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009291Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9292 QualType TargetType,
9293 bool Complain,
9294 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9295 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009296 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009297
9298 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9299 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009300 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9301 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009302 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009303 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9304 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9305 else
9306 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9307 }
9308 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9309 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9310 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9311 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9312 assert(Fn);
9313 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00009314 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009315 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009316 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009317
9318 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9319 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009320 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009321}
9322
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009323/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009324/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9325///
9326/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9327/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009328/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009329/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009330FunctionDecl *
9331Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9332 bool Complain,
9333 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009334 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9335 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9336 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009337 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9338 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9339 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009340
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009341 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009342 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009343 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009344
9345 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009346 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009347
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009348 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9349 // whose type matches exactly.
9350 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009351 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9352 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009353 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9354 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009355 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9356 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9357 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009358 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009359 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9360 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009361
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009362 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9363 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9364 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9365 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9366 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9367 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009368 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009369 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009370 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9371 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9372 Specialization, Info)) {
9373 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9374 (void)Result;
9375 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009376 }
9377
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009378 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9379
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009380 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009381 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009382 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009383 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9384 << ovl->getName();
9385 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009386 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009387 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009388 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009389
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009390 Matched = Specialization;
9391 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009392 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009393
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009394 return Matched;
9395}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009396
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009397
9398
9399
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009400// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9401// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9402//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009403// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009404//
9405// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9406// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9407// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9408bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9409 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9410 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009411 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009412 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009413 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009414
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009415 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009416
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009417 DeclAccessPair found;
9418 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9419 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9420 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009421 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009422 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9423 return true;
9424 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009425
9426 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9427 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9428 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9429 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9430 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9431 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9432 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009433 if (!complain) return false;
9434
9435 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9436 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9437 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9438
9439 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9440 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9441 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9442 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9443 // the static candidates were rejected.
9444 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9445 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009446 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009447
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009448 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009449 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009450 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009451
9452 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009453 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009454 SingleFunctionExpression =
9455 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009456 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9457 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9458 return true;
9459 }
9460 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009461 }
9462
9463 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9464 if (complain) {
9465 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9466 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9467 << DestTypeForComplaining
9468 << OpRangeForComplaining
9469 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009470 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9471
9472 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9473 return true;
9474 }
9475
9476 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009477 }
9478
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009479 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9480 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009481}
9482
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009483/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9484static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009485 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009486 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009487 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009488 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009489 bool PartialOverloading,
9490 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009491 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009492 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9493 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9494
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009495 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009496 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9497 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9498 return;
9499 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009500 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9501 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009502 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009503 }
9504
9505 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9506 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009507 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009508 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009509 return;
9510 }
9511
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009512 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009513}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009514
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009515/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9516/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009517void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009518 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009519 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9520 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009521
9522#ifndef NDEBUG
9523 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9524 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009525 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009526 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9527 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9528 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9529 //
9530 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9531 //
9532 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009533 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009534 //
9535 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9536 // template
9537 //
9538 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009539
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009540 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9541 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9542 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9543 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9544 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9545 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9546 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009547 }
9548 }
9549#endif
9550
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009551 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9552 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009553 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009554 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9555 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9556 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9557 }
9558
9559 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9560 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009561 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9562 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9563 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009564
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009565 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009566 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009567 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009568 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009569 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009570}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009571
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009572/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9573/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9574/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9575/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9576///
9577/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9578static bool
9579DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9580 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9581 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009582 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009583 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9584 return false;
9585
9586 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +00009587 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
9588 continue;
9589
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009590 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9591
9592 if (!R.empty()) {
9593 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9594
9595 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9596 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9597 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9598 R.clear();
9599 return false;
9600 }
9601
9602 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9603 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9604 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009605 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009606 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009607
9608 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009609 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009610 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9611 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009612 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009613 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009614 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009615
9616 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9617 // declaring the function there instead.
9618 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9619 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +00009620 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009621 AssociatedNamespaces,
9622 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009623 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Nick Lewyckyd05df512012-11-13 00:08:34 +00009624 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
9625 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9626 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
9627 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
Richard Smith19e0d952012-12-22 02:46:14 +00009628 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
9629 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
9630 continue;
9631
9632 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a reserved
9633 // name, like __gnu_cxx.
9634 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
9635 if (NS &&
9636 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
9637 continue;
9638
9639 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009640 }
9641
9642 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9643 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009644 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009645 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9646 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9647 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009648 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009649 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9650 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009651 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009652 } else {
9653 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9654 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9655 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9656 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9657 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9658 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9659 }
9660
9661 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9662 return true;
9663 }
9664
9665 R.clear();
9666 }
9667
9668 return false;
9669}
9670
9671/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9672/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9673/// was defined.
9674///
9675/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9676static bool
9677DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9678 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009679 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009680 DeclarationName OpName =
9681 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9682 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9683 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009684 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009685}
9686
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009687namespace {
9688// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9689// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9690// that accept the given number of arguments.
9691class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9692 public:
9693 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9694 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009695 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009696 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9697 }
9698
9699 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9700 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9701 return candidate.isKeyword();
9702
9703 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9704 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9705 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9706 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9707 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9708 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9709 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9710 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9711 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9712 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9713 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9714 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9715 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9716 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9717 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9718 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9719 return true;
9720 }
9721 }
9722 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9723 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9724 return true;
9725 }
9726 return false;
9727 }
9728
9729 private:
9730 unsigned NumArgs;
9731 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9732};
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009733
9734// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9735class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9736 public:
9737 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9738 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9739 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9740 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9741 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9742 }
9743
9744 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9745 return false;
9746 }
9747};
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009748
9749class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
9750 Sema &SemaRef;
9751public:
9752 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
9753 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
9754 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
9755 }
9756
9757 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
9758 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
9759 }
9760};
9761
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009762}
9763
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009764/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9765///
9766/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009767static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009768BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009769 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9770 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009771 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009772 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009773 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009774 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
9775 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
9776 //
9777 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
9778 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
9779 //
9780 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
9781 return ExprError();
9782 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009783
9784 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009785 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009786 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009787
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009788 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009789 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009790 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9791 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9792 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9793 }
9794
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009795 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9796 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009797 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009798 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9799 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9800 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9801 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009802 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009803 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009804 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009805 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009806 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009807 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009808
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009809 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9810
9811 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9812 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009813 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009814 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009815 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9816 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009817 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009818 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009819 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009820 else
9821 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9822
9823 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009824 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009825
9826 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009827 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009828 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009829 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009830 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
9831 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009832}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009833
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009834/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
9835/// the given function.
9836/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
9837bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9838 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9839 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9840 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9841 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9842 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009843#ifndef NDEBUG
9844 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9845 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9846 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9847
9848 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9849 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9850 FunctionDecl *F;
9851 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9852 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9853 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009854 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009855
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009856 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009857 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009858 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009859#endif
9860
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009861 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009862 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) {
9863 *Result = ExprError();
9864 return true;
9865 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009866
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009867 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9868 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009869 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009870 *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009871
9872 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009873 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9874 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009875 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009876 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9877 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009878 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009879 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009880 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009881 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00009882 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
9883 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
9884 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9885 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009886 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009887 *Result = Owned(CE);
9888 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009889 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009890 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009891 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009892
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009893 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009894 return false;
9895}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009896
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009897/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
9898/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
9899/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
9900static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9901 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9902 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9903 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9904 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9905 Expr *ExecConfig,
9906 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9907 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
9908 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
9909 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9910 if (CandidateSet->empty())
9911 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9912 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9913 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9914 AllowTypoCorrection);
9915
9916 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009917 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009918 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009919 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
9920 SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
9921 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9922 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9923 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009924 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009925
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009926 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9927 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9928 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009929 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009930 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9931 RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009932 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9933 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009934 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9935 return Recovery;
9936
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009937 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009938 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009939 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009940 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9941 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009942 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009943 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009944
9945 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009946 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009947 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009948 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9949 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009950 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009951
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009952 case OR_Deleted: {
9953 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9954 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
9955 << ULE->getName()
9956 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
9957 << Fn->getSourceRange();
9958 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9959 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009960
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009961 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9962 // the call in the AST.
9963 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
9964 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9965 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9966 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
9967 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009968 }
9969
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009970 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009971 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009972}
9973
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009974/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
9975/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9976/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9977/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9978/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
9979/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
9980ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9981 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9982 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9983 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9984 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9985 Expr *ExecConfig,
9986 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9987 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
9988 ExprResult result;
9989
9990 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, NumArgs, LParenLoc,
9991 &CandidateSet, &result))
9992 return result;
9993
9994 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9995 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
9996 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
9997
9998 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9999 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10000 &Best, OverloadResult,
10001 AllowTypoCorrection);
10002}
10003
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010004static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010005 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10006 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10007}
10008
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010009/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10010/// operator.
10011///
10012/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10013///
10014/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10015/// operator.
10016///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010017/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010018/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10019/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10020/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10021/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10022/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10023///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010024/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010025ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010026Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10027 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010028 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010029 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010030
10031 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10032 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10033 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010034 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10035 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010036
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010037 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10038 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010039
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010040 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
10041 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010042
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010043 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10044 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10045 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010046 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010047 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010048 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10049 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010050 NumArgs = 2;
10051 }
10052
10053 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010054 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010055 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010056 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010057 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010058 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010059 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010060
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010061 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010062 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010063 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010064 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010065 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10066 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010067 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010068 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010069 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010070 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010071 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010072 }
10073
10074 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010075 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010076
10077 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010078 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
10079 false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010080
10081 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10082 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
10083
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010084 // Add candidates from ADL.
10085 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010086 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010087 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10088 CandidateSet);
10089
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010090 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010091 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010092
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010093 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10094
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010095 // Perform overload resolution.
10096 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010097 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010098 case OR_Success: {
10099 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10100 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010101
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010102 if (FnDecl) {
10103 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10104 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010105
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010106 // Convert the arguments.
10107 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010108 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010109
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010110 ExprResult InputRes =
10111 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10112 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10113 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010114 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010115 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010116 } else {
10117 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010118 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010119 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010120 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010121 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010122 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010123 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010124 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010125 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010126 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010127 }
10128
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010129 // Determine the result type.
10130 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10131 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10132 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010133
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010134 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010135 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010136 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010137 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10138 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010139
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010140 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010141 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010142 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010143 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010144 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010145
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010146 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010147 FnDecl))
10148 return ExprError();
10149
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010150 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010151 } else {
10152 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10153 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10154 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010155 ExprResult InputRes =
10156 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10157 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10158 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10159 return ExprError();
10160 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010161 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010162 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010163 }
10164
10165 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010166 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10167 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10168 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010169 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc,
10170 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010171 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10172 return ExprError();
10173
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010174 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10175 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10176 break;
10177
10178 case OR_Ambiguous:
10179 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10180 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10181 << Input->getType()
10182 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010183 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10184 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010185 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10186 return ExprError();
10187
10188 case OR_Deleted:
10189 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10190 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10191 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10192 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10193 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010194 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10195 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010196 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010197 return ExprError();
10198 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010199
10200 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10201 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10202 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010203 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010204}
10205
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010206/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10207/// operator.
10208///
10209/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10210///
10211/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10212/// operator.
10213///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010214/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010215/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10216/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10217/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10218/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10219/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10220///
10221/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10222/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010223ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010224Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010225 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010226 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010227 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010228 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010229 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010230
10231 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10232 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10233 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10234
10235 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10236 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010237 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010238 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010239 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010240 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010241 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010242 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010243 Context.DependentTy,
10244 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010245 OpLoc,
10246 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010247
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010248 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10249 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010250 VK_LValue,
10251 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010252 Context.DependentTy,
10253 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010254 OpLoc,
10255 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010256 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010257
10258 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010259 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010260 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10261 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010262 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010263 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10264 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10265 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010266 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010267 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10268 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10269 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010270 }
10271
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010272 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10273 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10274 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010275
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010276 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10277 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10278 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010279 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10280 return ExprError();
10281
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010282 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10283 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10284 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10285 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10286 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10287 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010288 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010289 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010290
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010291 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10292 // create a built-in binary operator.
10293 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10294 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10295
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010296 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010297 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010298
10299 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010300 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010301
10302 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10303 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10304
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010305 // Add candidates from ADL.
10306 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010307 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010308 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10309 CandidateSet);
10310
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010311 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010312 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010313
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010314 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10315
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010316 // Perform overload resolution.
10317 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010318 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010319 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010320 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10321 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10322
10323 if (FnDecl) {
10324 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10325 // operator.
10326
10327 // Convert the arguments.
10328 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010329 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010330 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010331
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010332 ExprResult Arg1 =
10333 PerformCopyInitialization(
10334 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10335 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10336 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010337 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010338 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010339
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010340 ExprResult Arg0 =
10341 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10342 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10343 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010344 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010345 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010346 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010347 } else {
10348 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010349 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10350 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10351 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10352 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010353 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010354 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010355
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010356 ExprResult Arg1 =
10357 PerformCopyInitialization(
10358 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10359 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10360 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010361 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10362 return ExprError();
10363 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10364 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010365 }
10366
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010367 // Determine the result type.
10368 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10369 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10370 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010371
10372 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010373 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010374 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010375 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010376 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10377 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010378
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010379 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010380 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010381 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10382 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010383
10384 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010385 FnDecl))
10386 return ExprError();
10387
Nick Lewycky9b7ea0d2013-01-24 02:03:08 +000010388 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
10389 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
10390 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
10391 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
10392 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
10393 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
10394
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010395 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010396 } else {
10397 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10398 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10399 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010400 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10401 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10402 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10403 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010404 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010405 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010406
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010407 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10408 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10409 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10410 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10411 return ExprError();
10412 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010413 break;
10414 }
10415 }
10416
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010417 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10418 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10419 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10420 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10421 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010422 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010423 break;
10424
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010425 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10426 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10427 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010428 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010429 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010430 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010431 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10432 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010433 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010434 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010435 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10436 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10437 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010438 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010439 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10440 return ExprError();
10441
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010442 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10443 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10444 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010445 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010446 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010447 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10448 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010449 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010450 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010451 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010452 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010453
10454 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010455 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010456 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010457 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010458 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010459 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010460 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010461 return ExprError();
10462
10463 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010464 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10465 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10466 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010467 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
10468 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010469
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010470 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10471 // explain why it's deleted.
10472 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
10473 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010474 } else {
10475 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10476 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10477 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10478 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10479 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10480 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010481 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010482 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010483 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010484 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010485
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010486 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010487 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010488}
10489
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010490ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010491Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10492 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010493 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10494 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010495 DeclarationName OpName =
10496 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10497
10498 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10499 // expression.
10500 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10501
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010502 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010503 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10504 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10505 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010506 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010507 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010508 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010509 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10510 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10511 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010512 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010513
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010514 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010515 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010516 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010517 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010518 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010519 }
10520
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010521 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10522 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10523 return ExprError();
10524 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10525 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010526
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010527 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010528 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010529
10530 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10531
10532 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10533 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10534
10535 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10536 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10537
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010538 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10539
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010540 // Perform overload resolution.
10541 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010542 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010543 case OR_Success: {
10544 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10545 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10546
10547 if (FnDecl) {
10548 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10549 // operator.
10550
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010551 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010552
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010553 // Convert the arguments.
10554 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010555 ExprResult Arg0 =
10556 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10557 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10558 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010559 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010560 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010561
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010562 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010563 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010564 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010565 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010566 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010567 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010568 Owned(Args[1]));
10569 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10570 return ExprError();
10571
10572 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10573
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010574 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010575 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10576 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10577 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010578
10579 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010580 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10581 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010582 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010583 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010584 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010585 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10586 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010587 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10588 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010589
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010590 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10591 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010592 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010593 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10594 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010595
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010596 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010597 FnDecl))
10598 return ExprError();
10599
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010600 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010601 } else {
10602 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10603 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10604 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010605 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10606 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10607 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10608 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010609 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010610 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10611
10612 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10613 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10614 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10615 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10616 return ExprError();
10617 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010618
10619 break;
10620 }
10621 }
10622
10623 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010624 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10625 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10626 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10627 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10628 else
10629 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10630 << Args[0]->getType()
10631 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010632 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010633 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010634 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010635 }
10636
10637 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010638 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010639 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010640 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10641 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010642 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010643 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010644 return ExprError();
10645
10646 case OR_Deleted:
10647 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10648 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010649 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010650 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010651 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010652 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010653 return ExprError();
10654 }
10655
10656 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010657 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010658}
10659
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010660/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10661/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10662/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10663/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10664/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010665/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10666/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010667ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010668Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10669 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010670 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010671 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10672 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10673
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010674 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10675 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010676 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010677
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010678 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10679 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10680 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10681 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10682
10683 QualType fnType =
10684 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10685
10686 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10687 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10688 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10689
10690 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10691 // member function we're calling.
10692 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10693
10694 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10695 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10696 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10697 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10698
10699 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10700 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10701 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10702 if (difference) {
10703 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10704 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10705 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10706 << qualsString
10707 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10708 }
10709
10710 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010711 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10712 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010713 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10714
10715 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010716 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010717 call, 0))
10718 return ExprError();
10719
10720 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10721 return ExprError();
10722
10723 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10724 }
10725
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010726 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10727 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10728 return ExprError();
10729
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010730 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010731 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010732 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010733 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010734 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10735 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010736 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010737 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010738 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010739 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010740 } else {
10741 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010742 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010743
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010744 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010745 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10746 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10747 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010748
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010749 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010750 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010751
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010752 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10753 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10754 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10755 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10756 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10757 }
10758
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010759 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10760 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10761
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010762 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10763 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10764 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10765 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10766
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010767
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010768 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010769 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010770 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
10771 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010772 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010773 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10774 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010775 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010776 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010777
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010778 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010779 ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010780 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010781 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010782 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010783 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010784 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010785 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010786 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10787 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010788 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010789 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010790 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010791
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010792 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10793
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010794 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10795
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010796 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010797 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010798 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010799 case OR_Success:
10800 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010801 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010802 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010803 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010804 break;
10805
10806 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010807 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010808 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010809 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010810 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10811 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010812 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010813 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010814
10815 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010816 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010817 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010818 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10819 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010820 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010821 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010822
10823 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010824 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010825 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010826 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010827 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010828 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010829 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10830 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010831 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010832 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010833 }
10834
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010835 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010836
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010837 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10838 // non-member call based on that function.
10839 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10840 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10841 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10842 }
10843
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010844 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010845 }
10846
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010847 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10848 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10849 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10850
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010851 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010852 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010853 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10854 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010855 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010856
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010857 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010858 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010859 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010860 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010861
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010862 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010863 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10864 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010865 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10866 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10867 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10868 FoundDecl, Method);
10869 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10870 return ExprError();
10871 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10872 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010873
10874 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010875 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10876 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010877 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010878 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010879 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010880
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010881 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10882
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000010883 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010884 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010885
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010886 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10887 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10888 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10889 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10890
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010891 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010892 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10893 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10894 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10895 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10896
10897 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010898 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010899 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010900 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010901}
10902
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010903/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10904/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10905/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10906/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010907ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010908Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010909 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010910 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010911 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010912 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10913 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010914 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010915
10916 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10917 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10918 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010919
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010920 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10921 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010922
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010923 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10924 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010925 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010926 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10927 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10928 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10929 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010930 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010931 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010932
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010933 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000010934 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010935 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010936
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010937 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10938 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10939 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10940
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010941 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010942 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010943 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10944 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010945 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010946 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010947
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010948 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010949 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10950 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010951 //
10952 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10953 //
10954 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10955 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010956 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10957 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10958 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10959 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010960 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10961 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10962 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10963 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10964 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000010965 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
10966 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010967 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000010968 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
10969 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010970 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10971 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10972 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10973 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010974
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010975 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10976 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010977 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010978 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010979
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010980 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010981 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10982 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10983 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10984 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10985 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10986 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010987
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010988 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10989 {
10990 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010991 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10992 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010993 }
10994 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010995 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010996
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010997 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10998
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010999 // Perform overload resolution.
11000 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011001 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011002 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011003 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011004 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11005 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011006 break;
11007
11008 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011009 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011010 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011011 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11012 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011013 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011014 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011015 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011016 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011017 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11018 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011019 break;
11020
11021 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011022 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011023 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011024 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011025 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
11026 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011027 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011028
11029 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011030 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011031 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11032 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011033 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011034 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011035 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011036 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11037 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011038 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011039 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011040
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011041 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011042 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011043
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011044 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11045
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011046 if (Best->Function == 0) {
11047 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11048 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011049 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011050 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11051 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11052
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011053 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000011054 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011055
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011056 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11057 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11058 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011059
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011060 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011061 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011062 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11063 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011064 if (Call.isInvalid())
11065 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011066 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11067 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11068 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
11069 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011070
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011071 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000011072 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011073 }
11074
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011075 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011076
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011077 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11078 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11079 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11080 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011081
11082 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011083 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011084 return ExprError();
11085
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011086 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11087 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011088
11089 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
11090 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
11091
11092 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
11093 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
11094 // list).
11095 Expr **MethodArgs;
11096 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
11097 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11098 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
11099 } else {
11100 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
11101 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011102 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011103 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
11104 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011105
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011106 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11107 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11108 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011109 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011110 HadMultipleCandidates,
11111 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11112 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011113 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11114 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011115
11116 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11117 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011118 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11119 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11120 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11121
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011122 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011123 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011124 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs, NumArgs+1),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011125 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011126 delete [] MethodArgs;
11127
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011128 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011129 Method))
11130 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011131
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011132 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11133 // slots in the call for them.
11134 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011135 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011136 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
11137 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11138
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011139 bool IsError = false;
11140
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011141 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011142 ExprResult ObjRes =
11143 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11144 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11145 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11146 IsError = true;
11147 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011148 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011149 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011150
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011151 // Check the argument types.
11152 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011153 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011154 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011155 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011156
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011157 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011158
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011159 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011160 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011161 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011162 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011163 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011164
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011165 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11166 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011167 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011168 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011169 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11170 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11171 IsError = true;
11172 break;
11173 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011174
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011175 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011176 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011177
11178 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11179 }
11180
11181 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11182 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11183 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Aaron Ballman4914c282012-07-20 20:40:35 +000011184 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i < NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011185 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11186 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11187 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011188 }
11189 }
11190
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011191 if (IsError) return true;
11192
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011193 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
11194
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011195 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011196 return true;
11197
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011198 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011199}
11200
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011201/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011202/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011203/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011204ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011205Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011206 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11207 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011208
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011209 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11210 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011211
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011212 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11213
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011214 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11215 //
11216 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11217 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11218 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11219 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011220 DeclarationName OpName =
11221 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011222 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011223 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011224
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011225 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011226 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011227 return ExprError();
11228
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011229 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11230 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11231 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011232
11233 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011234 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011235 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
11236 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011237 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011238
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011239 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11240
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011241 // Perform overload resolution.
11242 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011243 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011244 case OR_Success:
11245 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11246 break;
11247
11248 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11249 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11250 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011251 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011252 else
11253 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011254 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011255 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011256 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011257
11258 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011259 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11260 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011261 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011262 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011263
11264 case OR_Deleted:
11265 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11266 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011267 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011268 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011269 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011270 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011271 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011272 }
11273
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011274 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
11275
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011276 // Convert the object parameter.
11277 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011278 ExprResult BaseResult =
11279 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11280 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11281 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011282 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011283 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011284
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011285 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011286 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011287 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011288 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11289 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011290
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011291 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11292 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11293 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011294 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011295 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011296 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011297
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011298 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011299 Method))
11300 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011301
11302 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011303}
11304
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011305/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11306/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11307ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11308 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11309 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11310 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11311 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11312 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011313
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011314 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11315 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11316 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011317
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011318 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11319
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011320 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11321 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11322 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11323 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11324 case OR_Success:
11325 case OR_Deleted:
11326 break;
11327
11328 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11329 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11330 << R.getLookupName();
11331 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11332 return ExprError();
11333
11334 case OR_Ambiguous:
11335 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11336 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11337 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011338 }
11339
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011340 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011341 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11342 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011343 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11344 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11345 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11346 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011347
11348 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11349 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011350 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
11351 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
11352 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11353 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11354 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11355 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11356 return true;
11357 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11358 }
11359
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011360 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11361 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11362 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11363
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011364 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011365 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11366 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011367 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11368
11369 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11370 return ExprError();
11371
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011372 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011373 return ExprError();
11374
11375 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11376}
11377
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011378/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11379/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11380/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11381/// dependent lookup.
11382/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11383/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11384/// is returned.
11385Sema::ForRangeStatus
11386Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11387 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11388 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11389 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11390 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11391 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11392 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11393 CandidateSet->clear();
11394 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11395 ExprResult MemberRef =
11396 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11397 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11398 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11399 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11400 MemberLookup,
11401 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11402 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11403 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11404 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11405 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11406 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11407 }
11408 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, MultiExprArg(), Loc, 0);
11409 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11410 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11411 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11412 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11413 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11414 }
11415 } else {
11416 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011417 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11418 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11419 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11420 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011421 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011422
11423 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, &Range, 1, Loc,
11424 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11425 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11426 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11427 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11428 }
11429 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11430 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11431 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11432
11433 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11434 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11435 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11436 }
11437 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, &Range, 1,
11438 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11439 OverloadResult,
11440 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11441 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11442 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11443 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11444 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11445 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11446 }
11447 }
11448 return FRS_Success;
11449}
11450
11451
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011452/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11453/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11454/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11455/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011456/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011457Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011458 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011459 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011460 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11461 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011462 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011463 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011464
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011465 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011466 }
11467
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011468 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011469 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11470 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011471 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011472 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011473 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011474 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011475 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011476 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011477
11478 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011479 ICE->getCastKind(),
11480 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011481 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011482 }
11483
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011484 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011485 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011486 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011487 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11488 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11489 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11490 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011491 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011492 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11493 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11494 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011495 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11496 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011497 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011498 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011499
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011500 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11501 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11502 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11503 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11504
11505 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11506 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11507 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11508 QualType ClassType
11509 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11510 QualType MemPtrType
11511 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11512
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011513 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11514 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11515 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011516 }
11517 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011518 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11519 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011520 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011521 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011522
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011523 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011524 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011525 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011526 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011527 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011528
11529 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011530 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11531 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011532 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011533 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11534 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011535 }
11536
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011537 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11538 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011539 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011540 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011541 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011542 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11543 Fn->getType(),
11544 VK_LValue,
11545 Found.getDecl(),
11546 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011547 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011548 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11549 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011550 }
11551
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011552 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011553 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011554 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11555 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11556 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11557 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11558 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011559
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011560 Expr *Base;
11561
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011562 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11563 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011564 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11565 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011566 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11567 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011568 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011569 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011570 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011571 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11572 Fn->getType(),
11573 VK_LValue,
11574 Found.getDecl(),
11575 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011576 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011577 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11578 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011579 } else {
11580 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11581 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011582 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011583 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011584 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11585 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11586 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11587 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011588 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011589 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011590
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011591 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11592 QualType type;
11593 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11594 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11595 type = Fn->getType();
11596 } else {
11597 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11598 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11599 }
11600
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011601 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11602 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11603 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011604 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011605 Fn,
11606 Found,
11607 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11608 TemplateArgs,
11609 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11610 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000011611 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011612 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011613 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011614
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011615 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011616}
11617
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011618ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011619 DeclAccessPair Found,
11620 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011621 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011622}
11623
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011624} // end namespace clang